• Home
  • Line#
  • Scopes#
  • Navigate#
  • Raw
  • Download
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
27 #include <net/regulatory.h>
28 
29 /**
30  * DOC: Introduction
31  *
32  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
33  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
34  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
35  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
36  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
37  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
38  *
39  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
40  * use restrictions.
41  */
42 
43 
44 /**
45  * DOC: Device registration
46  *
47  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
48  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
49  * described below.
50  *
51  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
52  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
53  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
54  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
55  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
56  * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
57  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
58  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
59  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
60  *
61  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
62  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
63  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
64  */
65 
66 struct wiphy;
67 
68 /*
69  * wireless hardware capability structures
70  */
71 
72 /**
73  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
74  *
75  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
76  *
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
78  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
79  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
80  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
81  *	channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
83  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
84  *	is not permitted.
85  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
86  *	is not permitted.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
88  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
89  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
90  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
91  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
92  *	restrictions.
93  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
94  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
95  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
96  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
97  *	restrictions.
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
100  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
101  *	on this channel.
102  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
103  *	on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
105  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106  *	on this channel.
107  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108  *	on this channel.
109  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
110  *	on this channel.
111  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
112  *	on this channel.
113  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
114  *	on this channel.
115  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
116  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
117  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
118  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
119  *	restrictions.
120  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
121  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
122  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
123  *	not permitted using this channel
124  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
125  *	not permitted using this channel
126  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
127  *	mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
128  *	even if it is otherwise disabled.
129  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation
130  *	with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
131  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity on a 20 MHz channel,
132  *	even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
133  */
134 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED			= BIT(0),
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR			= BIT(1),
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD			= BIT(2),
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR			= BIT(3),
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS		= BIT(4),
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS		= BIT(5),
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM			= BIT(6),
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ			= BIT(7),
143 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ		= BIT(8),
144 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY		= BIT(9),
145 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT		= BIT(10),
146 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ			= BIT(11),
147 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ			= BIT(12),
148 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE			= BIT(13),
149 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ			= BIT(14),
150 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ			= BIT(15),
151 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ			= BIT(16),
152 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ			= BIT(17),
153 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ			= BIT(18),
154 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ		= BIT(19),
155 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT			= BIT(20),
156 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT		= BIT(21),
157 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT	= BIT(22),
158 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT	= BIT(23),
159 	IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR		= BIT(24),
160 	IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP	= BIT(25),
161 	IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY     = BIT(26),
162 };
163 
164 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
165 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
166 
167 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
168 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
169 
170 /**
171  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
172  *
173  * This structure describes a single channel for use
174  * with cfg80211.
175  *
176  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
177  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
178  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
179  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
180  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
181  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
182  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
183  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
184  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
185  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
186  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
187  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
188  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
189  * @orig_mag: internal use
190  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
191  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
192  *	on this channel.
193  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
194  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
195  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
196  */
197 struct ieee80211_channel {
198 	enum nl80211_band band;
199 	u32 center_freq;
200 	u16 freq_offset;
201 	u16 hw_value;
202 	u32 flags;
203 	int max_antenna_gain;
204 	int max_power;
205 	int max_reg_power;
206 	bool beacon_found;
207 	u32 orig_flags;
208 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
209 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
210 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
211 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
212 	s8 psd;
213 };
214 
215 /**
216  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
217  *
218  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
219  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
220  * different bands/PHY modes.
221  *
222  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
223  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
224  *	with CCK rates.
225  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
226  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
227  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
228  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
229  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
230  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
231  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
232  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
233  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
234  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
235  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
236  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
237  */
238 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
239 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(0),
240 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= BIT(1),
241 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= BIT(2),
242 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= BIT(3),
243 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= BIT(4),
244 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= BIT(5),
245 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= BIT(6),
246 };
247 
248 /**
249  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
250  *
251  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
252  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
253  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
254  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
255  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
256  */
257 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
258 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
259 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
260 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
261 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
262 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
263 };
264 
265 /**
266  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
267  *
268  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
269  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
270  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
271  */
272 enum ieee80211_privacy {
273 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
274 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
275 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
276 };
277 
278 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
279 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
280 
281 /**
282  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
283  *
284  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
285  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
286  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
287  * passed around.
288  *
289  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
290  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
291  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
292  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
293  *	short preamble is used
294  */
295 struct ieee80211_rate {
296 	u32 flags;
297 	u16 bitrate;
298 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
299 };
300 
301 /**
302  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
303  *
304  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
305  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
306  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
307  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
308  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
309  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
310  *	members of the SRG
311  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
312  *	used by members of the SRG
313  */
314 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
315 	bool enable;
316 	u8 sr_ctrl;
317 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
318 	u8 min_offset;
319 	u8 max_offset;
320 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
321 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
322 };
323 
324 /**
325  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
326  *
327  * @color: the current color.
328  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
329  * @partial: define the AID equation.
330  */
331 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
332 	u8 color;
333 	bool enabled;
334 	bool partial;
335 };
336 
337 /**
338  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
339  *
340  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
341  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
342  *
343  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
344  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
345  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
346  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
347  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
348  */
349 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
350 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
351 	bool ht_supported;
352 	u8 ampdu_factor;
353 	u8 ampdu_density;
354 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
355 };
356 
357 /**
358  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
359  *
360  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
361  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
362  *
363  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
364  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
365  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
366  */
367 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
368 	bool vht_supported;
369 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
370 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
371 };
372 
373 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
374 
375 /**
376  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
377  *
378  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
379  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
380  *
381  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
382  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
383  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
384  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
385  */
386 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
387 	bool has_he;
388 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
389 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
390 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
391 };
392 
393 /**
394  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
395  *
396  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
397  * and NSS Set field"
398  *
399  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
400  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
401  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
402  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
403  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
404  */
405 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
406 	union {
407 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
408 		struct {
409 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
410 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
411 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
412 		} __packed bw;
413 	} __packed;
414 } __packed;
415 
416 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
417 
418 /**
419  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
420  *
421  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
422  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
423  *
424  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
425  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
426  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
427  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
428  */
429 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
430 	bool has_eht;
431 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
432 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
433 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
434 };
435 
436 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
437 #ifdef __CHECKER__
438 /*
439  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
440  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
441  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
442  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
443  */
444 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
445 #else
446 # define __iftd
447 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
448 
449 /**
450  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
451  *
452  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
453  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
454  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
455  *
456  * @types_mask: interface types mask
457  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
458  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
459  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
460  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
461  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
462  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
463  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
464  */
465 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
466 	u16 types_mask;
467 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
468 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
469 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
470 	struct {
471 		const u8 *data;
472 		unsigned int len;
473 	} vendor_elems;
474 };
475 
476 /**
477  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
478  *
479  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
480  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
481  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
482  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
483  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
484  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
485  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
486  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
487  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
488  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
489  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
490  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
491  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
492  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
493  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
494  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
495  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
496  */
497 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
498 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
499 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
500 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
501 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
502 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
503 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
504 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
505 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
506 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
507 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
508 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
509 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
510 };
511 
512 /**
513  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
514  *
515  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
516  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
517  *
518  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
519  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
520  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
521  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
522  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
523  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
524  */
525 struct ieee80211_edmg {
526 	u8 channels;
527 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
528 };
529 
530 /**
531  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
532  *
533  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
534  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
535  *
536  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
537  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
538  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
539  */
540 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
541 	bool s1g;
542 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
543 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
544 };
545 
546 /**
547  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
548  *
549  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
550  * is able to operate in.
551  *
552  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
553  *	in this band.
554  * @band: the band this structure represents
555  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
556  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
557  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
558  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
559  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
560  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
561  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
562  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
563  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
564  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
565  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
566  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
567  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
568  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
569  *	iftype_data).
570  */
571 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
572 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
573 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
574 	enum nl80211_band band;
575 	int n_channels;
576 	int n_bitrates;
577 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
578 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
579 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
580 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
581 	u16 n_iftype_data;
582 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
583 };
584 
585 /**
586  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
587  * @sband: the sband to initialize
588  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
589  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
590  *
591  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
592  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
593  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
594  */
595 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)596 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
597 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
598 				 u16 n_iftd)
599 {
600 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
601 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
602 }
603 
604 /**
605  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
606  * @sband: the sband to initialize
607  * @iftd: the iftype data array
608  */
609 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
610 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
611 
612 /**
613  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
614  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
615  * @i: iterator counter
616  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
617  */
618 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
619 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
620 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
621 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
622 
623 /**
624  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
625  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
626  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
627  *
628  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
629  */
630 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)631 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
632 				u8 iftype)
633 {
634 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
635 	int i;
636 
637 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES))
638 		return NULL;
639 
640 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
641 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
642 
643 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
644 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
645 			return data;
646 	}
647 
648 	return NULL;
649 }
650 
651 /**
652  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
653  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
654  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
655  *
656  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
657  */
658 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)659 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
660 			    u8 iftype)
661 {
662 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
663 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
664 
665 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
666 		return &data->he_cap;
667 
668 	return NULL;
669 }
670 
671 /**
672  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
673  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
674  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
675  *
676  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
677  */
678 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)679 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
680 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
681 {
682 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
683 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
684 
685 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
686 		return 0;
687 
688 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
689 }
690 
691 /**
692  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
693  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
694  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
695  *
696  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
697  */
698 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)699 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
700 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
701 {
702 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
703 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
704 
705 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
706 		return &data->eht_cap;
707 
708 	return NULL;
709 }
710 
711 /**
712  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
713  *
714  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
715  *
716  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
717  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
718  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
719  *
720  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
721  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
722  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
723  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
724  * without affecting other devices.
725  *
726  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
727  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
728  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
729  */
730 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
731 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
732 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)733 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
734 {
735 }
736 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
737 
738 
739 /*
740  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
741  */
742 
743 /**
744  * DOC: Actions and configuration
745  *
746  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
747  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
748  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
749  * operations use are described separately.
750  *
751  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
752  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
753  *
754  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
755  * in a separate chapter.
756  */
757 
758 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
759 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
760 
761 /**
762  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
763  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
764  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
765  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
766  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
767  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
768  *	determine the address as needed.
769  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
770  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
771  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
772  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
773  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
774  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
775  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
776  */
777 struct vif_params {
778 	u32 flags;
779 	int use_4addr;
780 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
781 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
782 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
783 };
784 
785 /**
786  * struct key_params - key information
787  *
788  * Information about a key
789  *
790  * @key: key material
791  * @key_len: length of key material
792  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
793  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
794  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
795  *	length given by @seq_len.
796  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
797  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
798  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
799  */
800 struct key_params {
801 	const u8 *key;
802 	const u8 *seq;
803 	int key_len;
804 	int seq_len;
805 	u16 vlan_id;
806 	u32 cipher;
807 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
808 };
809 
810 /**
811  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
812  * @chan: the (control) channel
813  * @width: channel width
814  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
815  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
816  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
817  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
818  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
819  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
820  *	parameters are ignored.
821  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
822  * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
823  *	bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
824  *	from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
825  */
826 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
827 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
828 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
829 	u32 center_freq1;
830 	u32 center_freq2;
831 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
832 	u16 freq1_offset;
833 	u16 punctured;
834 };
835 
836 /*
837  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
838  */
839 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
840 	struct {
841 		u32 legacy;
842 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
843 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
844 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
845 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
846 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
847 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
848 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
849 };
850 
851 
852 /**
853  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
854  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
855  *	of the peer.
856  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
857  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
858  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
859  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
860  * @retry_long: retry count value
861  * @retry_short: retry count value
862  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
863  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
864  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
865  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
866  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
867  */
868 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
869 	bool config_override;
870 	u8 tids;
871 	u64 mask;
872 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
873 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
874 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
875 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
876 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
877 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
878 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
879 };
880 
881 /**
882  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
883  * @peer: Station's MAC address
884  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
885  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
886  */
887 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
888 	const u8 *peer;
889 	u32 n_tid_conf;
890 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
891 };
892 
893 /**
894  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
895  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
896  * @kek: FILS KEK
897  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
898  * @snonce: STA Nonce
899  * @anonce: AP Nonce
900  */
901 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
902 	const u8 *macaddr;
903 	const u8 *kek;
904 	u8 kek_len;
905 	const u8 *snonce;
906 	const u8 *anonce;
907 };
908 
909 /**
910  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
911  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
912  *	addresses.
913  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
914  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
915  */
916 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
917 	const u8 *macaddr;
918 	bool enable;
919 };
920 
921 /**
922  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
923  * @chandef: the channel definition
924  *
925  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
926  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
927  */
928 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)929 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
930 {
931 	switch (chandef->width) {
932 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
933 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
934 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
935 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
936 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
937 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
938 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
939 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
940 	default:
941 		WARN_ON(1);
942 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
943 	}
944 }
945 
946 /**
947  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
948  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
949  * @channel: the control channel
950  * @chantype: the channel type
951  *
952  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
953  */
954 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
955 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
956 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
957 
958 /**
959  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
960  * @chandef1: first channel definition
961  * @chandef2: second channel definition
962  *
963  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
964  * identical, %false otherwise.
965  */
966 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)967 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
968 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
969 {
970 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
971 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
972 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
973 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
974 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
975 		chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
976 }
977 
978 /**
979  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
980  *
981  * @chandef: the channel definition
982  *
983  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
984  */
985 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)986 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
987 {
988 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
989 }
990 
991 /**
992  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
993  * @chandef1: first channel definition
994  * @chandef2: second channel definition
995  *
996  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
997  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
998  */
999 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
1000 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
1001 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
1002 
1003 /**
1004  * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
1005  * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1006  *
1007  * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1008  * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1009  */
1010 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1011 
1012 /**
1013  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1014  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1015  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1016  */
1017 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1018 
1019 /**
1020  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1021  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1022  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1023  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1024  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1025  */
1026 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1027 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1028 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1029 
1030 /**
1031  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1032  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1033  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1034  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1035  * Returns:
1036  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1037  */
1038 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1039 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1040 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1041 
1042 /**
1043  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1044  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1045  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1046  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1047  *
1048  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1049  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1050  */
1051 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1052 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1053 
1054 /**
1055  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1056  *				   channel definition
1057  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1058  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1059  *
1060  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1061  */
1062 unsigned int
1063 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1064 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1065 
1066 /**
1067  * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1068  * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1069  * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1070  * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1071  *	according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1072  *
1073  * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1074  *	for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1075  */
1076 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1077 			     enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1078 			     u16 *punctured);
1079 
1080 /**
1081  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1082  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1083  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1084  *
1085  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1086  **/
1087 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1088 
1089 /**
1090  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1091  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1092  *
1093  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1094  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1095  *
1096  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1097  */
1098 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1099 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1100 {
1101 	switch (width) {
1102 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1103 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1104 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1105 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1106 	default:
1107 		break;
1108 	}
1109 	return 0;
1110 }
1111 
1112 /**
1113  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1114  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1115  *
1116  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1117  *
1118  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1119  */
1120 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1121 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1122 {
1123 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1124 }
1125 
1126 /**
1127  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1128  *
1129  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1130  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1131  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1132  *
1133  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1134  *
1135  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1136  */
1137 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1138 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1139 {
1140 	switch (chandef->width) {
1141 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1142 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1143 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1144 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1145 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1146 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1147 	default:
1148 		break;
1149 	}
1150 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1151 }
1152 
1153 /**
1154  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1155  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1156  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1157  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1158  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1159  *
1160  * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1161  */
1162 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1163 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1164 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1165 
1166 /**
1167  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1168  *
1169  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1170  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1171  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1172  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1173  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1174  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1175  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1176  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1177  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1178  *
1179  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1180  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1181  */
1182 enum survey_info_flags {
1183 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1184 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1185 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1186 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1187 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1188 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1189 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1190 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1191 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1192 };
1193 
1194 /**
1195  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1196  *
1197  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1198  *	record to report global statistics
1199  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1200  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1201  *	optional
1202  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1203  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1204  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1205  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1206  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1207  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1208  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1209  *
1210  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1211  *
1212  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1213  * channel duty cycle etc.
1214  */
1215 struct survey_info {
1216 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1217 	u64 time;
1218 	u64 time_busy;
1219 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1220 	u64 time_rx;
1221 	u64 time_tx;
1222 	u64 time_scan;
1223 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1224 	u32 filled;
1225 	s8 noise;
1226 };
1227 
1228 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1229 
1230 /**
1231  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1232  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1233  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1234  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1235  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1236  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1237  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1238  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1239  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1240  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1241  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1242  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1243  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1244  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1245  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1246  *	protocol frames.
1247  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1248  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1249  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1250  *	port for mac80211
1251  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1252  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1253  *	offload)
1254  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1255  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1256  *
1257  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1258  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1259  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1260  *	  such a scenario.
1261  *
1262  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1263  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1264  *
1265  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1266  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1267  *
1268  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1269  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1270  */
1271 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1272 	u32 wpa_versions;
1273 	u32 cipher_group;
1274 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1275 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1276 	int n_akm_suites;
1277 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1278 	bool control_port;
1279 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1280 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1281 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1282 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1283 	const u8 *psk;
1284 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1285 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1286 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1287 
1288 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1289 };
1290 
1291 /**
1292  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1293  *
1294  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1295  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1296  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1297  */
1298 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1299 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1300 	u8 index;
1301 	bool ema;
1302 };
1303 
1304 /**
1305  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1306  *
1307  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1308  *
1309  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1310  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1311  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1312  */
1313 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1314 	u8 cnt;
1315 	struct {
1316 		const u8 *data;
1317 		size_t len;
1318 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1319 };
1320 
1321 /**
1322  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1323  *
1324  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1325  *
1326  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1327  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1328  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1329  */
1330 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1331 	u8 cnt;
1332 	struct {
1333 		const u8 *data;
1334 		size_t len;
1335 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1336 };
1337 
1338 /**
1339  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1340  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1341  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1342  *	or %NULL if not changed
1343  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1344  *	or %NULL if not changed
1345  * @head_len: length of @head
1346  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1347  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1348  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1349  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1350  *	frames or %NULL
1351  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1352  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1353  *	Response frames or %NULL
1354  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1355  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1356  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1357  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1358  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1359  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1360  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1361  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1362  *	(measurement type 8)
1363  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1364  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1365  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1366  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1367  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1368  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1369  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1370  */
1371 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1372 	unsigned int link_id;
1373 
1374 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1375 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1376 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1377 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1378 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1379 	const u8 *lci;
1380 	const u8 *civicloc;
1381 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1382 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1383 	s8 ftm_responder;
1384 
1385 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1386 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1387 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1388 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1389 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1390 	size_t lci_len;
1391 	size_t civicloc_len;
1392 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1393 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1394 
1395 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1396 };
1397 
1398 struct mac_address {
1399 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1400 };
1401 
1402 /**
1403  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1404  *
1405  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1406  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1407  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1408  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1409  */
1410 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1411 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1412 	int n_acl_entries;
1413 
1414 	/* Keep it last */
1415 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1416 };
1417 
1418 /**
1419  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1420  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1421  *
1422  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1423  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1424  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1425  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1426  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1427  *	frame headers.
1428  */
1429 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1430 	bool update;
1431 	u32 min_interval;
1432 	u32 max_interval;
1433 	size_t tmpl_len;
1434 	const u8 *tmpl;
1435 };
1436 
1437 /**
1438  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1439  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1440  *
1441  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1442  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1443  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1444  *	scanning
1445  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1446  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1447  */
1448 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1449 	bool update;
1450 	u32 interval;
1451 	size_t tmpl_len;
1452 	const u8 *tmpl;
1453 };
1454 
1455 /**
1456  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1457  *
1458  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1459  *
1460  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1461  * @beacon: beacon data
1462  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1463  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1464  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1465  *	user space)
1466  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1467  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1468  * @crypto: crypto settings
1469  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1470  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1471  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1472  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1473  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1474  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1475  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1476  *	MAC address based access control
1477  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1478  *	networks.
1479  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1480  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1481  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1482  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1483  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1484  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1485  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1486  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1487  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1488  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1489  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1490  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1491  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1492  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1493  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1494  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1495  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1496  */
1497 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1498 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1499 
1500 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1501 
1502 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1503 	const u8 *ssid;
1504 	size_t ssid_len;
1505 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1506 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1507 	bool privacy;
1508 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1509 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1510 	int inactivity_timeout;
1511 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1512 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1513 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1514 	bool pbss;
1515 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1516 
1517 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1518 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1519 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1520 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1521 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1522 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1523 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1524 	bool twt_responder;
1525 	u32 flags;
1526 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1527 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1528 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1529 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1530 
1531 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1532 };
1533 
1534 
1535 /**
1536  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1537  *
1538  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1539  *
1540  * @beacon: beacon data
1541  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1542  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1543  */
1544 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1545 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1546 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1547 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1548 
1549 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1550 };
1551 
1552 /**
1553  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1554  *
1555  * Used for channel switch
1556  *
1557  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1558  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1559  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1560  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1561  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1562  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1563  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1564  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1565  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1566  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1567  * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1568  *	MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1569  */
1570 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1571 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1572 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1573 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1574 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1575 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1576 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1577 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1578 	bool radar_required;
1579 	bool block_tx;
1580 	u8 count;
1581 	u8 link_id;
1582 
1583 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1584 };
1585 
1586 /**
1587  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1588  *
1589  * Used for bss color change
1590  *
1591  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1592  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1593  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1594  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1595  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1596  * @color: the color used after the change
1597  * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1598  *	0 in case of non-MLO.
1599  */
1600 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1601 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1602 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1603 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1604 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1605 	u8 count;
1606 	u8 color;
1607 	u8 link_id;
1608 };
1609 
1610 /**
1611  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1612  *
1613  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1614  *
1615  * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global
1616  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1617  *	to use for verification
1618  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1619  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1620  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1621  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1622  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1623  *	nl80211_iftype.
1624  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1625  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1626  *	the verification
1627  */
1628 struct iface_combination_params {
1629 	int radio_idx;
1630 	int num_different_channels;
1631 	u8 radar_detect;
1632 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1633 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1634 };
1635 
1636 /**
1637  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1638  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1639  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1640  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1641  *
1642  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1643  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1644  */
1645 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1646 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1647 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1648 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1649 };
1650 
1651 /**
1652  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1653  *
1654  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1655  *
1656  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1657  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1658  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1659  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1660  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1661  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1662  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1663  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1664  *	per peer TPC.
1665  */
1666 struct sta_txpwr {
1667 	s16 power;
1668 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1669 };
1670 
1671 /**
1672  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1673  *
1674  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1675  *
1676  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1677  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1678  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1679  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1680  *	(or NULL for no change)
1681  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1682  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1683  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1684  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1685  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1686  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1687  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1688  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1689  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1690  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1691  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1692  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1693  */
1694 struct link_station_parameters {
1695 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1696 	int link_id;
1697 	const u8 *link_mac;
1698 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1699 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1700 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1701 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1702 	u8 opmode_notif;
1703 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1704 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1705 	u8 he_capa_len;
1706 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1707 	bool txpwr_set;
1708 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1709 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1710 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1711 
1712 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1713 };
1714 
1715 /**
1716  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1717  *
1718  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1719  *
1720  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1721  * @link_id: the link id
1722  */
1723 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1724 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1725 	u32 link_id;
1726 };
1727 
1728 /**
1729  * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1730  *
1731  * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1732  *
1733  * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1734  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1735  * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1736  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1737  */
1738 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1739 	u16 dlink[8];
1740 	u16 ulink[8];
1741 };
1742 
1743 /**
1744  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1745  *
1746  * Used to change and create a new station.
1747  *
1748  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1749  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1750  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1751  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1752  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1753  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1754  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1755  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1756  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1757  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1758  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1759  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1760  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1761  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1762  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1763  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1764  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1765  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1766  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1767  *	to unknown)
1768  * @capability: station capability
1769  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1770  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1771  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1772  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1773  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1774  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1775  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1776  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1777  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1778  */
1779 struct station_parameters {
1780 	struct net_device *vlan;
1781 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1782 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1783 	int listen_interval;
1784 	u16 aid;
1785 	u16 vlan_id;
1786 	u16 peer_aid;
1787 	u8 plink_action;
1788 	u8 plink_state;
1789 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1790 	u8 max_sp;
1791 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1792 	u16 capability;
1793 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1794 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1795 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1796 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1797 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1798 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1799 	int support_p2p_ps;
1800 	u16 airtime_weight;
1801 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1802 };
1803 
1804 /**
1805  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1806  *
1807  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1808  *
1809  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1810  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1811  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1812  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1813  * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1814  *	using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1815  *	remove all stations.
1816  */
1817 struct station_del_parameters {
1818 	const u8 *mac;
1819 	u8 subtype;
1820 	u16 reason_code;
1821 	int link_id;
1822 };
1823 
1824 /**
1825  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1826  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1827  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1828  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1829  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1830  *	the AP MLME in the device
1831  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1832  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1833  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1834  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1835  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1836  *	supported/used)
1837  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1838  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1839  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1840  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1841  */
1842 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1843 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1844 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1845 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1846 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1847 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1848 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1849 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1850 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1851 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1852 };
1853 
1854 /**
1855  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1856  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1857  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1858  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1859  *
1860  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1861  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1862  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1863  *
1864  * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1865  * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1866  * use them before calling this.
1867  */
1868 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1869 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1870 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1871 
1872 /**
1873  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1874  *
1875  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1876  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1877  *
1878  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1879  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1880  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1881  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1882  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1883  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1884  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1885  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1886  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1887  */
1888 enum rate_info_flags {
1889 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1890 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1891 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1892 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1893 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1894 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1895 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1896 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1897 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1898 };
1899 
1900 /**
1901  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1902  *
1903  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1904  *
1905  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1906  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1907  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1908  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1909  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1910  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1911  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1912  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1913  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1914  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1915  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1916  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1917  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1918  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1919  */
1920 enum rate_info_bw {
1921 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1922 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1923 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1924 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1925 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1926 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1927 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1928 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1929 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1930 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1931 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1932 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1933 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1934 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1935 };
1936 
1937 /**
1938  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1939  *
1940  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1941  *
1942  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1943  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1944  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1945  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1946  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1947  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1948  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1949  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1950  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1951  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1952  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1953  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1954  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1955  */
1956 struct rate_info {
1957 	u16 flags;
1958 	u16 legacy;
1959 	u8 mcs;
1960 	u8 nss;
1961 	u8 bw;
1962 	u8 he_gi;
1963 	u8 he_dcm;
1964 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1965 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1966 	u8 eht_gi;
1967 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1968 };
1969 
1970 /**
1971  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1972  *
1973  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1974  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1975  *
1976  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1977  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1978  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1979  */
1980 enum bss_param_flags {
1981 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= BIT(0),
1982 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(1),
1983 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= BIT(2),
1984 };
1985 
1986 /**
1987  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1988  *
1989  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1990  *
1991  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1992  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1993  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1994  */
1995 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1996 	u8 flags;
1997 	u8 dtim_period;
1998 	u16 beacon_interval;
1999 };
2000 
2001 /**
2002  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
2003  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
2004  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2005  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
2006  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
2007  * @flows: number of new flows seen
2008  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
2009  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
2010  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
2011  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
2012  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
2013  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
2014  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
2015  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
2016  */
2017 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
2018 	u32 filled;
2019 	u32 backlog_bytes;
2020 	u32 backlog_packets;
2021 	u32 flows;
2022 	u32 drops;
2023 	u32 ecn_marks;
2024 	u32 overlimit;
2025 	u32 overmemory;
2026 	u32 collisions;
2027 	u32 tx_bytes;
2028 	u32 tx_packets;
2029 	u32 max_flows;
2030 };
2031 
2032 /**
2033  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2034  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2035  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2036  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2037  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2038  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2039  *	transmitted MSDUs
2040  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2041  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2042  */
2043 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2044 	u32 filled;
2045 	u64 rx_msdu;
2046 	u64 tx_msdu;
2047 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2048 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2049 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2050 };
2051 
2052 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
2053 
2054 /**
2055  * struct station_info - station information
2056  *
2057  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2058  *
2059  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2060  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2061  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2062  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2063  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2064  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2065  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2066  * @llid: mesh local link id
2067  * @plid: mesh peer link id
2068  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2069  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2070  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2071  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2072  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2073  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2074  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2075  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2076  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2077  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2078  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2079  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2080  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2081  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2082  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2083  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2084  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2085  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2086  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2087  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2088  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2089  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2090  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2091  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2092  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2093  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2094  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2095  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2096  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2097  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2098  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2099  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2100  *	towards this station.
2101  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2102  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2103  *	from this peer
2104  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2105  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2106  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2107  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2108  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2109  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2110  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2111  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2112  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2113  *	been sent.
2114  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2115  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2116  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2117  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2118  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2119  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2120  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2121  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2122  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2123  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2124  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2125  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2126  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2127  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2128  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2129  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2130  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2131  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2132  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2133  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2134  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2135  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2136  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2137  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2138  */
2139 struct station_info {
2140 	u64 filled;
2141 	u32 connected_time;
2142 	u32 inactive_time;
2143 	u64 assoc_at;
2144 	u64 rx_bytes;
2145 	u64 tx_bytes;
2146 	u16 llid;
2147 	u16 plid;
2148 	u8 plink_state;
2149 	s8 signal;
2150 	s8 signal_avg;
2151 
2152 	u8 chains;
2153 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2154 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2155 
2156 	struct rate_info txrate;
2157 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2158 	u32 rx_packets;
2159 	u32 tx_packets;
2160 	u32 tx_retries;
2161 	u32 tx_failed;
2162 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2163 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2164 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2165 
2166 	int generation;
2167 
2168 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2169 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2170 
2171 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2172 	s64 t_offset;
2173 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2174 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2175 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2176 
2177 	u32 expected_throughput;
2178 
2179 	u64 tx_duration;
2180 	u64 rx_duration;
2181 	u64 rx_beacon;
2182 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2183 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2184 
2185 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2186 	s8 ack_signal;
2187 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2188 
2189 	u16 airtime_weight;
2190 
2191 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2192 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2193 
2194 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2195 
2196 	u8 connected_to_as;
2197 
2198 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2199 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2200 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2201 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2202 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2203 
2204 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2205 };
2206 
2207 /**
2208  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2209  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2210  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2211  */
2212 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2213 	s32 power;
2214 	u32 freq_range_index;
2215 };
2216 
2217 /**
2218  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2219  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2220  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2221  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2222  */
2223 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2224 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2225 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2226 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs);
2227 };
2228 
2229 
2230 /**
2231  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2232  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2233  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2234  */
2235 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2236 	u32 start_freq;
2237 	u32 end_freq;
2238 };
2239 
2240 /**
2241  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2242  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2243  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2244  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2245  *
2246  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2247  * range to small ones and then append them.
2248  */
2249 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2250 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2251 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2252 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2253 };
2254 
2255 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2256 /**
2257  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2258  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2259  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2260  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2261  *
2262  * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2263  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2264  * considered undefined.
2265  */
2266 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2267 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2268 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2269 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2270 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2271 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2272 {
2273 	return -ENOENT;
2274 }
2275 #endif
2276 
2277 /**
2278  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2279  *
2280  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2281  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2282  *
2283  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2284  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2285  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2286  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2287  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2288  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2289  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2290  */
2291 enum monitor_flags {
2292 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID),
2293 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL),
2294 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL),
2295 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL),
2296 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS),
2297 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES),
2298 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE),
2299 };
2300 
2301 /**
2302  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2303  *
2304  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2305  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2306  *
2307  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2308  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2309  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2310  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2311  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2312  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2313  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2314  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2315  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2316  */
2317 enum mpath_info_flags {
2318 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2319 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2320 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2321 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2322 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2323 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2324 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2325 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2326 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2327 };
2328 
2329 /**
2330  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2331  *
2332  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2333  *
2334  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2335  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2336  * @sn: target sequence number
2337  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2338  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2339  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2340  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2341  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2342  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2343  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2344  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2345  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2346  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2347  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2348  */
2349 struct mpath_info {
2350 	u32 filled;
2351 	u32 frame_qlen;
2352 	u32 sn;
2353 	u32 metric;
2354 	u32 exptime;
2355 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2356 	u8 discovery_retries;
2357 	u8 flags;
2358 	u8 hop_count;
2359 	u32 path_change_count;
2360 
2361 	int generation;
2362 };
2363 
2364 /**
2365  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2366  *
2367  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2368  *
2369  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2370  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2371  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2372  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2373  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2374  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2375  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2376  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2377  *	(or NULL for no change)
2378  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2379  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2380  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2381  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2382  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2383  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2384  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2385  */
2386 struct bss_parameters {
2387 	int link_id;
2388 	int use_cts_prot;
2389 	int use_short_preamble;
2390 	int use_short_slot_time;
2391 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2392 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2393 	int ap_isolate;
2394 	int ht_opmode;
2395 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2396 };
2397 
2398 /**
2399  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2400  *
2401  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2402  *
2403  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2404  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2405  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2406  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2407  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2408  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2409  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2410  *	mesh interface
2411  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2412  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2413  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2414  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2415  *	elements
2416  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2417  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2418  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2419  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2420  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2421  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2422  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2423  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2424  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2425  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2426  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2427  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2428  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2429  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2430  *	element
2431  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2432  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2433  *	element
2434  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2435  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2436  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2437  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2438  *	announcements are transmitted
2439  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2440  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2441  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2442  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2443  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2444  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2445  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2446  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2447  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2448  *	station to establish a peer link
2449  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2450  *
2451  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2452  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2453  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2454  *
2455  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2456  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2457  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2458  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2459  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2460  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2461  *	setting for new peer links.
2462  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2463  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2464  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2465  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2466  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2467  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2468  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2469  *	in the mesh formation field.
2470  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2471  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2472  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2473  *      in the mesh path table
2474  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2475  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2476  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2477  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2478  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2479  */
2480 struct mesh_config {
2481 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2482 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2483 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2484 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2485 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2486 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2487 	u8 element_ttl;
2488 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2489 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2490 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2491 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2492 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2493 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2494 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2495 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2496 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2497 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2498 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2499 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2500 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2501 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2502 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2503 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2504 	u16 ht_opmode;
2505 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2506 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2507 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2508 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2509 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2510 	u32 plink_timeout;
2511 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2512 
2513 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2514 };
2515 
2516 /**
2517  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2518  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2519  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2520  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2521  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2522  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2523  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2524  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2525  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2526  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2527  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2528  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2529  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2530  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2531  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2532  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2533  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2534  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2535  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2536  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2537  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2538  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2539  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2540  *
2541  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2542  */
2543 struct mesh_setup {
2544 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2545 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2546 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2547 	u8 sync_method;
2548 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2549 	u8 path_metric;
2550 	u8 auth_id;
2551 	const u8 *ie;
2552 	u8 ie_len;
2553 	bool is_authenticated;
2554 	bool is_secure;
2555 	bool user_mpm;
2556 	u8 dtim_period;
2557 	u16 beacon_interval;
2558 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2559 	u32 basic_rates;
2560 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2561 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2562 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2563 
2564 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2565 };
2566 
2567 /**
2568  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2569  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2570  *
2571  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2572  */
2573 struct ocb_setup {
2574 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2575 };
2576 
2577 /**
2578  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2579  * @ac: AC identifier
2580  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2581  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2582  *	1..32767]
2583  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2584  *	1..32767]
2585  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2586  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2587  */
2588 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2589 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2590 	u16 txop;
2591 	u16 cwmin;
2592 	u16 cwmax;
2593 	u8 aifs;
2594 	int link_id;
2595 };
2596 
2597 /**
2598  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2599  *
2600  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2601  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2602  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2603  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2604  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2605  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2606  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2607  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2608  * in the wiphy structure.
2609  *
2610  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2611  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2612  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2613  *
2614  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2615  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2616  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2617  * to userspace.
2618  */
2619 
2620 /**
2621  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2622  * @ssid: the SSID
2623  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2624  */
2625 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2626 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2627 	u8 ssid_len;
2628 };
2629 
2630 /**
2631  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2632  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2633  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2634  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2635  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2636  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2637  *	userspace will be notified of that
2638  */
2639 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2640 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2641 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2642 	bool aborted;
2643 };
2644 
2645 /**
2646  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2647  *
2648  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2649  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2650  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2651  *	 which the above info is relevant to
2652  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2653  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2654  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2655  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2656  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2657  */
2658 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2659 	u32 short_ssid;
2660 	u32 channel_idx;
2661 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2662 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2663 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2664 	bool psc_no_listen;
2665 	s8 psd_20;
2666 };
2667 
2668 /**
2669  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2670  *
2671  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2672  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2673  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2674  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2675  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2676  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2677  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2678  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2679  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2680  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2681  *	%duration field.
2682  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2683  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2684  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2685  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2686  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2687  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2688  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2689  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2690  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2691  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2692  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2693  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2694  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2695  *	true if this is the second scan request
2696  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2697  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2698  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2699  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2700  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2701  */
2702 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2703 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2704 	int n_ssids;
2705 	u32 n_channels;
2706 	const u8 *ie;
2707 	size_t ie_len;
2708 	u16 duration;
2709 	bool duration_mandatory;
2710 	u32 flags;
2711 
2712 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2713 
2714 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2715 
2716 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2717 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2718 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2719 
2720 	/* internal */
2721 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2722 	unsigned long scan_start;
2723 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2724 	bool notified;
2725 	bool no_cck;
2726 	bool scan_6ghz;
2727 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2728 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2729 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2730 
2731 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2732 
2733 	/* keep last */
2734 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2735 };
2736 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2737 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2738 {
2739 	int i;
2740 
2741 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2742 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2743 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2744 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2745 	}
2746 }
2747 
2748 /**
2749  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2750  *
2751  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2752  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2753  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2754  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2755  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2756  */
2757 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2758 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2759 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2760 	s32 rssi_thold;
2761 };
2762 
2763 /**
2764  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2765  *
2766  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2767  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2768  *	infinite loop.
2769  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2770  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2771  */
2772 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2773 	u32 interval;
2774 	u32 iterations;
2775 };
2776 
2777 /**
2778  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2779  *
2780  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2781  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2782  */
2783 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2784 	enum nl80211_band band;
2785 	s8 delta;
2786 };
2787 
2788 /**
2789  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2790  *
2791  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2792  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2793  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2794  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2795  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2796  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2797  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2798  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2799  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2800  *	(others are filtered out).
2801  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2802  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2803  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2804  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2805  * @dev: the interface
2806  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2807  * @channels: channels to scan
2808  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2809  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2810  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2811  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2812  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2813  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2814  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2815  *	index must be executed first.
2816  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2817  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2818  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2819  *	owned by a particular socket)
2820  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2821  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2822  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2823  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2824  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2825  *	supported.
2826  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2827  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2828  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2829  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2830  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2831  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2832  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2833  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2834  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2835  *	comparisons.
2836  */
2837 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2838 	u64 reqid;
2839 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2840 	int n_ssids;
2841 	u32 n_channels;
2842 	const u8 *ie;
2843 	size_t ie_len;
2844 	u32 flags;
2845 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2846 	int n_match_sets;
2847 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2848 	u32 delay;
2849 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2850 	int n_scan_plans;
2851 
2852 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2853 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2854 
2855 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2856 	s8 relative_rssi;
2857 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2858 
2859 	/* internal */
2860 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2861 	struct net_device *dev;
2862 	unsigned long scan_start;
2863 	bool report_results;
2864 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2865 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2866 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2867 	struct list_head list;
2868 
2869 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2870 
2871 	/* keep last */
2872 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2873 };
2874 
2875 /**
2876  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2877  *
2878  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2879  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2880  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2881  */
2882 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2883 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2884 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2885 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2886 };
2887 
2888 /**
2889  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2890  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2891  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2892  *	signal type
2893  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2894  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2895  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2896  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2897  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2898  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2899  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2900  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2901  *	by %parent_bssid.
2902  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2903  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2904  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2905  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2906  * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2907  *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2908  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2909  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2910  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2911  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2912  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2913  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2914  */
2915 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2916 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2917 	s32 signal;
2918 	u64 boottime_ns;
2919 	u64 parent_tsf;
2920 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2921 	u8 chains;
2922 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2923 
2924 	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2925 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2926 
2927 	void *drv_data;
2928 };
2929 
2930 /**
2931  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2932  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2933  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2934  * @len: length of the IEs
2935  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2936  * @data: IE data
2937  */
2938 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2939 	u64 tsf;
2940 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2941 	int len;
2942 	bool from_beacon;
2943 	u8 data[];
2944 };
2945 
2946 /**
2947  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2948  *
2949  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2950  * for use in scan results and similar.
2951  *
2952  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2953  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2954  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2955  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2956  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2957  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2958  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2959  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2960  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2961  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2962  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2963  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2964  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2965  * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2966  *	cannot rely on it having valid data
2967  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2968  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2969  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2970  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2971  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2972  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2973  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2974  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2975  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2976  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2977  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2978  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2979  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2980  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2981  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2982  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2983  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2984  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2985  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2986  */
2987 struct cfg80211_bss {
2988 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2989 
2990 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2991 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2992 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2993 
2994 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2995 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2996 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2997 
2998 	s32 signal;
2999 
3000 	u16 beacon_interval;
3001 	u16 capability;
3002 
3003 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
3004 	u8 chains;
3005 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
3006 
3007 	u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
3008 
3009 	u8 bssid_index;
3010 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
3011 
3012 	u8 use_for;
3013 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
3014 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3015 
3016 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
3017 };
3018 
3019 /**
3020  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
3021  * @bss: the bss to search
3022  * @id: the element ID
3023  *
3024  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3025  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3026  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3027  */
3028 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
3029 
3030 /**
3031  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3032  * @bss: the bss to search
3033  * @id: the element ID
3034  *
3035  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3036  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3037  * Return: %NULL if not found.
3038  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3039 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3040 {
3041 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3042 }
3043 
3044 
3045 /**
3046  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3047  *
3048  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3049  * authentication.
3050  *
3051  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3052  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
3053  * @supported_selectors: List of selectors that should be assumed to be
3054  *	supported by the station.
3055  *	SAE_H2E must be assumed supported if set to %NULL.
3056  * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3057  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3058  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3059  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3060  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3061  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3062  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3063  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3064  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3065  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3066  *	transaction sequence number field.
3067  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3068  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3069  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3070  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3071  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3072  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3073  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3074  */
3075 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3076 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3077 	const u8 *ie;
3078 	size_t ie_len;
3079 	const u8 *supported_selectors;
3080 	u8 supported_selectors_len;
3081 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3082 	const u8 *key;
3083 	u8 key_len;
3084 	s8 key_idx;
3085 	const u8 *auth_data;
3086 	size_t auth_data_len;
3087 	s8 link_id;
3088 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3089 };
3090 
3091 /**
3092  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3093  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3094  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3095  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3096  * @elems_len: length of the elements
3097  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3098  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3099  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3100  *	operation as a whole must fail.
3101  */
3102 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3103 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3104 	const u8 *elems;
3105 	size_t elems_len;
3106 	bool disabled;
3107 	int error;
3108 };
3109 
3110 /**
3111  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3112  *
3113  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3114  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3115  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3116  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3117  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3118  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3119  *	request (connect callback).
3120  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3121  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3122  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3123  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3124  *	flag is not set.
3125  * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3126  */
3127 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3128 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3129 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3130 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3131 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3132 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3133 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3134 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3135 	ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU			= BIT(7),
3136 };
3137 
3138 /**
3139  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3140  *
3141  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3142  * (re)association.
3143  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3144  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3145  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3146  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3147  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3148  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3149  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3150  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3151  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3152  * @crypto: crypto settings
3153  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3154  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3155  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3156  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3157  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3158  *	frame.
3159  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3160  * @supported_selectors: supported selectors in IEEE 802.11 format
3161  *	(or %NULL for no change).
3162  *	If %NULL, then support for SAE_H2E should be assumed.
3163  * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3164  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3165  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3166  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3167  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3168  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3169  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3170  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3171  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3172  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3173  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3174  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3175  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3176  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3177  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3178  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3179  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3180  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3181  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3182  */
3183 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3184 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3185 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3186 	size_t ie_len;
3187 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3188 	bool use_mfp;
3189 	u32 flags;
3190 	const u8 *supported_selectors;
3191 	u8 supported_selectors_len;
3192 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3193 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3194 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3195 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3196 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3197 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3198 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3199 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3200 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3201 	s8 link_id;
3202 
3203 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3204 };
3205 
3206 /**
3207  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3208  *
3209  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3210  * deauthentication.
3211  *
3212  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3213  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3214  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3215  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3216  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3217  *	do not set a deauth frame
3218  */
3219 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3220 	const u8 *bssid;
3221 	const u8 *ie;
3222 	size_t ie_len;
3223 	u16 reason_code;
3224 	bool local_state_change;
3225 };
3226 
3227 /**
3228  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3229  *
3230  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3231  * disassociation.
3232  *
3233  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3234  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3235  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3236  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3237  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3238  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3239  */
3240 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3241 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3242 	const u8 *ie;
3243 	size_t ie_len;
3244 	u16 reason_code;
3245 	bool local_state_change;
3246 };
3247 
3248 /**
3249  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3250  *
3251  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3252  * method.
3253  *
3254  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3255  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3256  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3257  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3258  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3259  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3260  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3261  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3262  * @ie_len: length of that
3263  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3264  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3265  *	after joining
3266  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3267  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3268  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3269  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3270  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3271  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3272  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3273  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3274  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3275  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3276  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3277  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3278  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3279  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3280  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3281  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3282  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3283  */
3284 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3285 	const u8 *ssid;
3286 	const u8 *bssid;
3287 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3288 	const u8 *ie;
3289 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3290 	u16 beacon_interval;
3291 	u32 basic_rates;
3292 	bool channel_fixed;
3293 	bool privacy;
3294 	bool control_port;
3295 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3296 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3297 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3298 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3299 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3300 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3301 	int wep_tx_key;
3302 
3303 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3304 };
3305 
3306 /**
3307  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3308  *
3309  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3310  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3311  * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3312  * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3313  */
3314 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3315 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3316 	union {
3317 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3318 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3319 	} param;
3320 };
3321 
3322 /**
3323  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3324  *
3325  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3326  * authentication and association.
3327  *
3328  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3329  *	on scan results)
3330  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3331  *	%NULL if not specified
3332  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3333  *	results)
3334  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3335  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3336  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3337  *	to use.
3338  * @ssid: SSID
3339  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3340  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3341  * @ie: IEs for association request
3342  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3343  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3344  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3345  * @crypto: crypto settings
3346  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3347  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3348  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3349  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3350  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3351  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3352  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3353  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3354  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3355  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3356  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3357  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3358  *	networks.
3359  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3360  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3361  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3362  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3363  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3364  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3365  *	frame.
3366  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3367  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3368  *	data IE.
3369  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3370  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3371  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3372  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3373  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3374  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3375  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3376  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3377  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3378  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3379  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3380  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3381  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3382  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3383  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3384  */
3385 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3386 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3387 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3388 	const u8 *bssid;
3389 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3390 	const u8 *ssid;
3391 	size_t ssid_len;
3392 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3393 	const u8 *ie;
3394 	size_t ie_len;
3395 	bool privacy;
3396 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3397 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3398 	const u8 *key;
3399 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3400 	u32 flags;
3401 	int bg_scan_period;
3402 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3403 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3404 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3405 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3406 	bool pbss;
3407 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3408 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3409 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3410 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3411 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3412 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3413 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3414 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3415 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3416 	bool want_1x;
3417 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3418 
3419 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3420 };
3421 
3422 /**
3423  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3424  *
3425  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3426  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3427  *
3428  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3429  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3430  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3431  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3432  */
3433 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3434 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3435 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3436 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3437 };
3438 
3439 /**
3440  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3441  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3442  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3443  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3444  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3445  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3446  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3447  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3448  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3449  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3450  */
3451 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3452 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= BIT(0),
3453 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= BIT(1),
3454 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= BIT(2),
3455 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= BIT(3),
3456 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= BIT(4),
3457 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= BIT(5),
3458 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= BIT(6),
3459 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= BIT(7),
3460 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= BIT(8),
3461 };
3462 
3463 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3464 
3465 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3466 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3467 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3468 
3469 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3470 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3471 
3472 /**
3473  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3474  *
3475  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3476  * caching.
3477  *
3478  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3479  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3480  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3481  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3482  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3483  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3484  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3485  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3486  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3487  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3488  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3489  *	%NULL).
3490  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3491  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3492  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3493  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3494  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3495  *	used for it expires.
3496  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3497  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3498  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3499  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3500  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3501  */
3502 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3503 	const u8 *bssid;
3504 	const u8 *pmkid;
3505 	const u8 *pmk;
3506 	size_t pmk_len;
3507 	const u8 *ssid;
3508 	size_t ssid_len;
3509 	const u8 *cache_id;
3510 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3511 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3512 };
3513 
3514 /**
3515  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3516  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3517  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3518  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3519  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3520  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3521  *
3522  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3523  * memory, free @mask only!
3524  */
3525 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3526 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3527 	int pattern_len;
3528 	int pkt_offset;
3529 };
3530 
3531 /**
3532  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3533  *
3534  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3535  * @src: source IP address
3536  * @dst: destination IP address
3537  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3538  * @src_port: source port
3539  * @dst_port: destination port
3540  * @payload_len: data payload length
3541  * @payload: data payload buffer
3542  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3543  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3544  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3545  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3546  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3547  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3548  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3549  */
3550 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3551 	struct socket *sock;
3552 	__be32 src, dst;
3553 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3554 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3555 	int payload_len;
3556 	const u8 *payload;
3557 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3558 	u32 data_interval;
3559 	u32 wake_len;
3560 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3561 	u32 tokens_size;
3562 	/* must be last, variable member */
3563 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3564 };
3565 
3566 /**
3567  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3568  *
3569  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3570  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3571  *	operating as normal during suspend
3572  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3573  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3574  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3575  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3576  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3577  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3578  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3579  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3580  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3581  *	NULL if not configured.
3582  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3583  */
3584 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3585 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3586 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3587 	     rfkill_release;
3588 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3589 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3590 	int n_patterns;
3591 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3592 };
3593 
3594 /**
3595  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3596  *
3597  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3598  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3599  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3600  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3601  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3602  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3603  */
3604 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3605 	int delay;
3606 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3607 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3608 	int n_patterns;
3609 };
3610 
3611 /**
3612  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3613  *
3614  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3615  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3616  * @n_rules: number of rules
3617  */
3618 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3619 	int n_rules;
3620 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules);
3621 };
3622 
3623 /**
3624  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3625  *
3626  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3627  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3628  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3629  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3630  *	occurred (in MHz)
3631  */
3632 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3633 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3634 	int n_channels;
3635 	u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
3636 };
3637 
3638 /**
3639  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3640  *
3641  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3642  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3643  *	match information.
3644  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3645  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3646  */
3647 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3648 	int n_matches;
3649 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches);
3650 };
3651 
3652 /**
3653  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3654  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3655  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3656  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3657  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3658  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3659  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3660  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3661  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3662  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3663  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3664  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3665  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3666  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3667  *	it is.
3668  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3669  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3670  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3671  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3672  * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3673  *	disassoc frame (in MFP).
3674  */
3675 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3676 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3677 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3678 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3679 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3680 	     unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3681 	s32 pattern_idx;
3682 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3683 	const void *packet;
3684 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3685 };
3686 
3687 /**
3688  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3689  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3690  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3691  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3692  * @kek_len: length of kek
3693  * @kck_len: length of kck
3694  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3695  */
3696 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3697 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3698 	u32 akm;
3699 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3700 };
3701 
3702 /**
3703  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3704  *
3705  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3706  *
3707  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3708  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3709  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3710  */
3711 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3712 	u16 md;
3713 	const u8 *ie;
3714 	size_t ie_len;
3715 };
3716 
3717 /**
3718  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3719  *
3720  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3721  *
3722  * @chan: channel to use
3723  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3724  * @wait: duration for ROC
3725  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3726  * @len: buffer length
3727  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3728  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3729  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3730  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3731  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3732  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3733  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3734  */
3735 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3736 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3737 	bool offchan;
3738 	unsigned int wait;
3739 	const u8 *buf;
3740 	size_t len;
3741 	bool no_cck;
3742 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3743 	int n_csa_offsets;
3744 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3745 	int link_id;
3746 };
3747 
3748 /**
3749  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3750  *
3751  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3752  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3753  */
3754 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3755 	u8 dscp;
3756 	u8 up;
3757 };
3758 
3759 /**
3760  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3761  *
3762  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3763  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3764  */
3765 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3766 	u8 low;
3767 	u8 high;
3768 };
3769 
3770 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3771 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3772 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3773 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3774 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3775 
3776 /**
3777  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3778  *
3779  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3780  *
3781  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3782  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3783  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3784  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3785  */
3786 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3787 	u8 num_des;
3788 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3789 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3790 };
3791 
3792 /**
3793  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3794  *
3795  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3796  *
3797  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3798  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3799  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3800  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3801  */
3802 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3803 	u8 master_pref;
3804 	u8 bands;
3805 };
3806 
3807 /**
3808  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3809  * configuration
3810  *
3811  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3812  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3813  */
3814 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3815 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3816 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3817 };
3818 
3819 /**
3820  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3821  *
3822  * @filter: the content of the filter
3823  * @len: the length of the filter
3824  */
3825 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3826 	const u8 *filter;
3827 	u8 len;
3828 };
3829 
3830 /**
3831  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3832  *
3833  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3834  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3835  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3836  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3837  *	implementation specific.
3838  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3839  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3840  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3841  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3842  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3843  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3844  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3845  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3846  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3847  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3848  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3849  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3850  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3851  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3852  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3853  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3854  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3855  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3856  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3857  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3858  */
3859 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3860 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3861 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3862 	u8 publish_type;
3863 	bool close_range;
3864 	bool publish_bcast;
3865 	bool subscribe_active;
3866 	u8 followup_id;
3867 	u8 followup_reqid;
3868 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3869 	u32 ttl;
3870 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3871 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3872 	bool srf_include;
3873 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3874 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3875 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3876 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3877 	int srf_num_macs;
3878 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3879 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3880 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3881 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3882 	u8 instance_id;
3883 	u64 cookie;
3884 
3885 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3886 };
3887 
3888 /**
3889  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3890  *
3891  * @aa: authenticator address
3892  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3893  * @pmk: the PMK material
3894  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3895  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3896  *	holds PMK-R0.
3897  */
3898 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3899 	const u8 *aa;
3900 	u8 pmk_len;
3901 	const u8 *pmk;
3902 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3903 };
3904 
3905 /**
3906  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3907  *
3908  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3909  *
3910  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3911  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3912  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3913  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3914  *	authentication response command interface.
3915  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3916  *	authentication response command interface.
3917  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3918  *	authentication request event interface.
3919  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3920  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3921  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3922  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3923  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3924  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3925  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3926  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3927  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3928  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3929  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3930  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3931  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3932  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3933  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3934  *	chosen for the authentication.
3935  */
3936 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3937 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3938 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3939 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3940 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3941 	u16 status;
3942 	const u8 *pmkid;
3943 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3944 };
3945 
3946 /**
3947  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3948  *
3949  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3950  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3951  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3952  *	answered
3953  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3954  *	successfully answered
3955  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3956  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3957  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3958  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3959  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3960  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3961  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3962  *	the responder
3963  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3964  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3965  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3966  */
3967 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3968 	u32 filled;
3969 	u32 success_num;
3970 	u32 partial_num;
3971 	u32 failed_num;
3972 	u32 asap_num;
3973 	u32 non_asap_num;
3974 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3975 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3976 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3977 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3978 };
3979 
3980 /**
3981  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3982  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3983  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3984  *	reason than just "failure"
3985  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3986  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3987  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3988  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3989  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3990  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3991  *	by the responder
3992  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3993  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3994  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3995  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3996  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3997  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3998  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3999  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
4000  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
4001  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
4002  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
4003  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
4004  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
4005  *	the square root of the variance)
4006  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
4007  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
4008  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
4009  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
4010  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
4011  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
4012  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
4013  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
4014  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
4015  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
4016  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
4017  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
4018  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
4019  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
4020  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
4021  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
4022  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
4023  */
4024 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
4025 	const u8 *lci;
4026 	const u8 *civicloc;
4027 	unsigned int lci_len;
4028 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
4029 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
4030 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
4031 	s16 burst_index;
4032 	u8 busy_retry_time;
4033 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4034 	u8 burst_duration;
4035 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4036 	s32 rssi_avg;
4037 	s32 rssi_spread;
4038 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
4039 	s64 rtt_avg;
4040 	s64 rtt_variance;
4041 	s64 rtt_spread;
4042 	s64 dist_avg;
4043 	s64 dist_variance;
4044 	s64 dist_spread;
4045 
4046 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
4047 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
4048 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
4049 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
4050 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
4051 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
4052 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
4053 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
4054 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
4055 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
4056 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
4057 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
4058 
4059 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4060 };
4061 
4062 /**
4063  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4064  * @addr: address of the peer
4065  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4066  *	measurement was made)
4067  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4068  * @status: status of the measurement
4069  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4070  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
4071  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4072  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4073  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4074  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
4075  * @ftm: FTM result
4076  */
4077 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4078 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4079 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4080 
4081 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4082 
4083 	u8 final:1,
4084 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
4085 
4086 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4087 
4088 	union {
4089 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4090 	};
4091 };
4092 
4093 /**
4094  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4095  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4096  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4097  * @burst_period: burst period to use
4098  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4099  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4100  * @burst_duration: burst duration
4101  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4102  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4103  * @request_lci: request LCI information
4104  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4105  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4106  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4107  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4108  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4109  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4110  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4111  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4112  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4113  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4114  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4115  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4116  *
4117  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4118  */
4119 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4120 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4121 	u16 burst_period;
4122 	u8 requested:1,
4123 	   asap:1,
4124 	   request_lci:1,
4125 	   request_civicloc:1,
4126 	   trigger_based:1,
4127 	   non_trigger_based:1,
4128 	   lmr_feedback:1;
4129 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4130 	u8 burst_duration;
4131 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4132 	u8 ftmr_retries;
4133 	u8 bss_color;
4134 };
4135 
4136 /**
4137  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4138  * @addr: MAC address
4139  * @chandef: channel to use
4140  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4141  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4142  */
4143 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4144 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4145 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4146 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4147 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4148 };
4149 
4150 /**
4151  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4152  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4153  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4154  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4155  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4156  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4157  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4158  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4159  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4160  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4161  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4162  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4163  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4164  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4165  */
4166 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4167 	u64 cookie;
4168 	void *drv_data;
4169 	u32 n_peers;
4170 	u32 nl_portid;
4171 
4172 	u32 timeout;
4173 
4174 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4175 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4176 
4177 	struct list_head list;
4178 
4179 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4180 };
4181 
4182 /**
4183  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4184  *
4185  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4186  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4187  *
4188  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4189  *
4190  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4191  *	has to be done.
4192  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4193  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4194  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4195  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4196  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4197  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4198  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4199  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4200  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4201  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4202  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4203  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4204  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4205  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4206  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4207  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4208  */
4209 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4210 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4211 	u16 status;
4212 	const u8 *ie;
4213 	size_t ie_len;
4214 	int assoc_link_id;
4215 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4216 };
4217 
4218 /**
4219  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4220  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4221  *	for the entire device
4222  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4223  *	for the given interface
4224  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4225  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4226  *	for these subtypes
4227  */
4228 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4229 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4230 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4231 };
4232 
4233 /**
4234  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4235  *
4236  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4237  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4238  *
4239  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4240  * on success or a negative error code.
4241  *
4242  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4243  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4244  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4245  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4246  *
4247  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4248  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4249  *	configured for the device.
4250  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4251  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4252  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4253  *	the device.
4254  *
4255  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4256  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4257  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4258  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4259  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4260  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4261  *
4262  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4263  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4264  *
4265  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4266  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4267  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4268  *
4269  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4270  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4271  *	address is available.
4272  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4273  *
4274  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4275  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4276  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4277  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4278  *
4279  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4280  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4281  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4282  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4283  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4284  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4285  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4286  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4287  *
4288  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4289  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4290  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4291  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4292  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4293  *
4294  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4295  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4296  *
4297  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4298  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4299  *
4300  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4301  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4302  *
4303  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4304  *
4305  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4306  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4307  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4308  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4309  *
4310  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4311  * @del_station: Remove a station
4312  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4313  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4314  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4315  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4316  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4317  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4318  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4319  *
4320  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4321  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4322  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4323  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4324  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4325  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4326  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4327  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4328  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4329  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4330  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4331  *
4332  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4333  *
4334  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4335  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4336  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4337  *
4338  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4339  *
4340  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4341  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4342  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4343  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4344  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4345  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4346  *
4347  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4348  *
4349  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4350  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4351  *	join the mesh instead.
4352  *
4353  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4354  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4355  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4356  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4357  *
4358  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4359  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4360  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4361  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4362  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4363  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4364  *
4365  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4366  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4367  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4368  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4369  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4370  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4371  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4372  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4373  *
4374  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4375  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4376  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4377  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4378  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4379  *	was received.
4380  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4381  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4382  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4383  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4384  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4385  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4386  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4387  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4388  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4389  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4390  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4391  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4392  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4393  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4394  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4395  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4396  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4397  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4398  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4399  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4400  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4401  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4402  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4403  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4404  *
4405  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4406  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4407  *	to a merge.
4408  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4409  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4410  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4411  *
4412  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4413  *	MESH mode)
4414  *
4415  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4416  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4417  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4418  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4419  *
4420  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4421  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4422  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4423  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4424  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4425  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4426  *	return 0 if successful
4427  *
4428  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4429  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4430  *
4431  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4432  *
4433  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4434  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4435  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4436  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4437  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4438  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4439  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4440  *	the duration value.
4441  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4442  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4443  *	frame on another channel
4444  *
4445  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4446  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4447  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4448  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4449  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4450  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4451  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4452  *
4453  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4454  *
4455  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4456  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4457  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4458  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4459  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4460  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4461  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4462  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4463  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4464  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4465  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4466  *	disabled.)
4467  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4468  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4469  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4470  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4471  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4472  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4473  *	thresholds.
4474  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4475  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4476  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4477  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4478  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4479  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4480  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4481  *
4482  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4483  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4484  *
4485  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4486  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4487  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4488  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4489  *
4490  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4491  *
4492  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4493  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4494  *
4495  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4496  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4497  *
4498  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4499  *
4500  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4501  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4502  *	current monitoring channel.
4503  *
4504  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4505  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4506  *
4507  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4508  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4509  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4510  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4511  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4512  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4513  *
4514  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4515  *
4516  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4517  *	was finished on another phy.
4518  *
4519  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4520  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4521  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4522  *
4523  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4524  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4525  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4526  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4527  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4528  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4529  *
4530  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4531  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4532  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4533  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4534  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4535  *	as soon as possible.
4536  *
4537  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4538  *
4539  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4540  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4541  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4542  *
4543  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4544  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4545  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4546  *	account.
4547  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4548  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4549  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4550  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4551  *	rejected)
4552  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4553  *
4554  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4555  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4556  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4557  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4558  *
4559  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4560  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4561  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4562  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4563  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4564  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4565  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4566  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4567  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4568  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4569  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4570  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4571  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4572  *	provided @nan_func.
4573  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4574  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4575  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4576  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4577  *
4578  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4579  *
4580  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4581  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4582  *
4583  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4584  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4585  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4586  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4587  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4588  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4589  *
4590  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4591  *     user space
4592  *
4593  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4594  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4595  *
4596  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4597  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4598  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4599  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4600  *
4601  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4602  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4603  *	DH IE through this interface.
4604  *
4605  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4606  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4607  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4608  *	This callback may sleep.
4609  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4610  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4611  *
4612  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4613  *
4614  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4615  *
4616  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4617  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4618  *	Response frame.
4619  *
4620  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4621  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4622  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4623  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4624  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4625  *	radar channel.
4626  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4627  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4628  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4629  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4630  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4631  *
4632  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4633  * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4634  * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use.
4635  *	(invoked with the wiphy mutex held)
4636  * @assoc_ml_reconf: Request a non-AP MLO connection to perform ML
4637  *	reconfiguration, i.e., add and/or remove links to/from the
4638  *	association using ML reconfiguration action frames. Successfully added
4639  *	links will be added to the set of valid links. Successfully removed
4640  *	links will be removed from the set of valid links. The driver must
4641  *	indicate removed links by calling cfg80211_links_removed() and added
4642  *	links by calling cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). When calling
4643  *	cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done() the bss pointer must be given for each
4644  *	link for which MLO reconfiguration 'add' operation was requested.
4645  */
4646 struct cfg80211_ops {
4647 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4648 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4649 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4650 
4651 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4652 						  const char *name,
4653 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4654 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4655 						  struct vif_params *params);
4656 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4657 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4658 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4659 				       struct net_device *dev,
4660 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4661 				       struct vif_params *params);
4662 
4663 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4664 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4665 				 unsigned int link_id);
4666 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4667 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4668 				 unsigned int link_id);
4669 
4670 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4671 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4672 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4673 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4674 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4675 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4676 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4677 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4678 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4679 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4680 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4681 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4682 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4683 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4684 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4685 					u8 key_index);
4686 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4687 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4688 					  int link_id,
4689 					  u8 key_index);
4690 
4691 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4692 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4693 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4694 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4695 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4696 			   unsigned int link_id);
4697 
4698 
4699 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4700 			       const u8 *mac,
4701 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4702 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4703 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4704 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4705 				  const u8 *mac,
4706 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4707 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4709 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4710 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4711 
4712 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4713 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4714 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4715 			       const u8 *dst);
4716 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4717 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4718 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4719 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4720 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4721 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4722 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4723 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4724 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4725 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4726 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4727 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4728 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4729 				struct net_device *dev,
4730 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4731 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4732 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4733 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4734 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4735 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4736 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4737 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4738 
4739 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4740 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4741 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4742 
4743 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4744 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4745 
4746 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4747 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4748 
4749 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4750 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4751 
4752 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4753 					     struct net_device *dev,
4754 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4755 
4756 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4757 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4758 
4759 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4760 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4761 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4762 
4763 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4764 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4765 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4766 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4767 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4768 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4769 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4770 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4771 
4772 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4773 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4774 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4775 					 struct net_device *dev,
4776 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4777 					 u32 changed);
4778 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4779 			      u16 reason_code);
4780 
4781 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4782 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4783 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4784 
4785 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4786 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4787 
4788 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4789 
4790 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4791 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4792 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4793 				int *dbm);
4794 
4795 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4796 
4797 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4798 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4799 				void *data, int len);
4800 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4801 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4802 				 void *data, int len);
4803 #endif
4804 
4805 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4806 				    struct net_device *dev,
4807 				    unsigned int link_id,
4808 				    const u8 *peer,
4809 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4810 
4811 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4812 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4813 
4814 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4815 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4816 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4817 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4818 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4819 
4820 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4821 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4822 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4823 				     unsigned int duration,
4824 				     u64 *cookie);
4825 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4826 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4827 					    u64 cookie);
4828 
4829 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4830 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4831 			   u64 *cookie);
4832 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4833 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4834 				       u64 cookie);
4835 
4836 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4837 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4838 
4839 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4840 				       struct net_device *dev,
4841 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4842 
4843 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4844 					     struct net_device *dev,
4845 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4846 
4847 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4848 				      struct net_device *dev,
4849 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4850 
4851 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4852 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4853 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4854 
4855 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4856 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4857 
4858 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4859 				struct net_device *dev,
4860 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4861 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4862 				   u64 reqid);
4863 
4864 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4865 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4866 
4867 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4868 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4869 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4870 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4871 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4872 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4873 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4874 
4875 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4876 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4877 
4878 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4879 				  struct net_device *dev,
4880 				  u16 noack_map);
4881 
4882 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4883 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4884 			       unsigned int link_id,
4885 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4886 
4887 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4888 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4889 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4890 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4891 
4892 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4893 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4894 
4895 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4896 					 struct net_device *dev,
4897 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4898 					 u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id);
4899 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4900 			   struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id);
4901 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4902 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4903 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4904 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4905 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4906 				    u16 duration);
4907 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4908 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4909 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4910 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4911 
4912 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4913 				  struct net_device *dev,
4914 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4915 
4916 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4917 			       struct net_device *dev,
4918 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4919 
4920 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4921 				    unsigned int link_id,
4922 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4923 
4924 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4925 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4926 			     u16 admitted_time);
4927 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4928 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4929 
4930 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4931 				       struct net_device *dev,
4932 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4933 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4934 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4935 					      struct net_device *dev,
4936 					      const u8 *addr);
4937 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4938 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4939 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4940 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4941 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4942 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4943 			       u64 cookie);
4944 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4945 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4946 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4947 				   u32 changes);
4948 
4949 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4950 					    struct net_device *dev,
4951 					    const bool enabled);
4952 
4953 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4954 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4955 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4956 
4957 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4958 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4959 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4960 			   const u8 *aa);
4961 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4962 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4963 
4964 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4965 				   struct net_device *dev,
4966 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4967 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4968 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4969 				   u64 *cookie);
4970 
4971 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4972 				struct net_device *dev,
4973 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4974 
4975 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4976 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4977 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4978 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4979 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4980 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4981 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4982 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4983 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4984 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4985 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4986 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4987 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4988 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4989 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4990 				struct net_device *dev,
4991 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4992 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4993 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4994 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4995 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4996 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4997 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4998 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4999 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
5000 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5001 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
5002 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5003 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
5004 	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5005 			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
5006 	u32	(*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
5007 	int     (*assoc_ml_reconf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
5008 				   struct cfg80211_assoc_link *add_links,
5009 				   u16 rem_links);
5010 
5011 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5012 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
5013 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
5014 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
5015 };
5016 
5017 /*
5018  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
5019  * and registration/helper functions
5020  */
5021 
5022 /**
5023  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
5024  *
5025  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
5026  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
5027  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
5028  *	wiphy at all
5029  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
5030  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
5031  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
5032  *	reason to override the default
5033  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
5034  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
5035  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
5036  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
5037  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
5038  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
5039  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
5040  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
5041  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
5042  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
5043  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
5044  *	firmware.
5045  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
5046  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
5047  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
5048  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
5049  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
5050  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
5051  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
5052  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
5053  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
5054  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
5055  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
5056  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
5057  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
5058  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
5059  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
5060  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
5061  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
5062  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
5063  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
5064  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
5065  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
5066  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
5067  *	should set this flag for now.
5068  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
5069  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
5070  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
5071  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
5072  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
5073  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5074  *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5075  * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5076  */
5077 enum wiphy_flags {
5078 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
5079 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
5080 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
5081 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
5082 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
5083 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
5084 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
5085 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
5086 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
5087 	WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT			= BIT(9),
5088 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
5089 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
5090 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
5091 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
5092 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
5093 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
5094 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
5095 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
5096 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
5097 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
5098 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
5099 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
5100 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
5101 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
5102 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
5103 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
5104 };
5105 
5106 /**
5107  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5108  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5109  * @types: interface types (bits)
5110  */
5111 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5112 	u16 max;
5113 	u16 types;
5114 };
5115 
5116 /**
5117  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5118  *
5119  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5120  * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio,
5121  * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on
5122  * that radio.
5123  *
5124  * Examples:
5125  *
5126  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5127  *
5128  *    .. code-block:: c
5129  *
5130  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5131  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5132  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5133  *	};
5134  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5135  *		.limits = limits1,
5136  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5137  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5138  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5139  *	};
5140  *
5141  *
5142  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5143  *
5144  *    .. code-block:: c
5145  *
5146  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5147  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5148  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5149  *	};
5150  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5151  *		.limits = limits2,
5152  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5153  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5154  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5155  *	};
5156  *
5157  *
5158  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5159  *
5160  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5161  *
5162  *    .. code-block:: c
5163  *
5164  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5165  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5166  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5167  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5168  *	};
5169  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5170  *		.limits = limits3,
5171  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5172  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5173  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5174  *	};
5175  *
5176  */
5177 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5178 	/**
5179 	 * @limits:
5180 	 * limits for the given interface types
5181 	 */
5182 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5183 
5184 	/**
5185 	 * @num_different_channels:
5186 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5187 	 */
5188 	u32 num_different_channels;
5189 
5190 	/**
5191 	 * @max_interfaces:
5192 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5193 	 */
5194 	u16 max_interfaces;
5195 
5196 	/**
5197 	 * @n_limits:
5198 	 * number of limitations
5199 	 */
5200 	u8 n_limits;
5201 
5202 	/**
5203 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5204 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5205 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5206 	 */
5207 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5208 
5209 	/**
5210 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5211 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5212 	 */
5213 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5214 
5215 	/**
5216 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5217 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5218 	 */
5219 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5220 
5221 	/**
5222 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5223 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5224 	 *
5225 	 * = 0
5226 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5227 	 * > 0
5228 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5229 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5230 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5231 	 */
5232 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5233 };
5234 
5235 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5236 	u16 tx, rx;
5237 };
5238 
5239 /**
5240  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5241  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5242  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5243  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5244  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5245  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5246  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5247  *	(see nl80211.h)
5248  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5249  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5250  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5251  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5252  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5253  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5254  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5255  */
5256 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5257 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5258 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5259 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5260 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5261 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5262 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5263 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5264 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5265 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5266 };
5267 
5268 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5269 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5270 	u32 data_payload_max;
5271 	u32 data_interval_max;
5272 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5273 	bool seq;
5274 };
5275 
5276 /**
5277  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5278  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5279  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5280  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5281  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5282  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5283  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5284  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5285  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5286  *	scheduled scans.
5287  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5288  *	details.
5289  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5290  */
5291 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5292 	u32 flags;
5293 	int n_patterns;
5294 	int pattern_max_len;
5295 	int pattern_min_len;
5296 	int max_pkt_offset;
5297 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5298 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5299 };
5300 
5301 /**
5302  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5303  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5304  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5305  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5306  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5307  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5308  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5309  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5310  */
5311 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5312 	int n_rules;
5313 	int max_delay;
5314 	int n_patterns;
5315 	int pattern_max_len;
5316 	int pattern_min_len;
5317 	int max_pkt_offset;
5318 };
5319 
5320 /**
5321  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5322  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5323  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5324  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5325  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5326  */
5327 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5328 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5329 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5330 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5331 };
5332 
5333 /**
5334  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5335  *
5336  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5337  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5338  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5339  *
5340  */
5341 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5342 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5343 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5344 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5345 };
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5349  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5350  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5351  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5352  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5353  */
5354 
5355 struct sta_opmode_info {
5356 	u32 changed;
5357 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5358 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5359 	u8 rx_nss;
5360 };
5361 
5362 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5363 
5364 /**
5365  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5366  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5367  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5368  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5369  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5370  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5371  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5372  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5373  *	dumpit calls.
5374  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5375  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5376  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5377  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5378  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5379  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5380  * are used with dump requests.
5381  */
5382 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5383 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5384 	u32 flags;
5385 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5386 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5387 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5388 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5389 		      unsigned long *storage);
5390 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5391 	unsigned int maxattr;
5392 
5393 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5394 };
5395 
5396 /**
5397  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5398  * @iftype: interface type
5399  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5400  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5401  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5402  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5403  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5404  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5405  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5406  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5407  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5408  */
5409 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5410 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5411 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5412 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5413 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5414 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5415 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5416 };
5417 
5418 /**
5419  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5420  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5421  * @type: the interface type to look up
5422  *
5423  * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5424  */
5425 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5426 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5427 
5428 /**
5429  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5430  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5431  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5432  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5433  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5434  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5435  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5436  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5437  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5438  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5439  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5440  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5441  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5442  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5443  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5444  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5445  *	not limited)
5446  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5447  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5448  */
5449 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5450 	unsigned int max_peers;
5451 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5452 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5453 
5454 	struct {
5455 		u32 preambles;
5456 		u32 bandwidths;
5457 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5458 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5459 		u8 supported:1,
5460 		   asap:1,
5461 		   non_asap:1,
5462 		   request_lci:1,
5463 		   request_civicloc:1,
5464 		   trigger_based:1,
5465 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5466 	} ftm;
5467 };
5468 
5469 /**
5470  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5471  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5472  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5473  *
5474  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5475  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5476  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5477  */
5478 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5479 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5480 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5481 	int n_akm_suites;
5482 };
5483 
5484 /**
5485  * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range
5486  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency (kHz)
5487  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency (kHz)
5488  */
5489 struct wiphy_radio_freq_range {
5490 	u32 start_freq;
5491 	u32 end_freq;
5492 };
5493 
5494 
5495 /**
5496  * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy
5497  * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy.
5498  * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel
5499  * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio.
5500  *
5501  * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on.
5502  * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range
5503  *
5504  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5505  *	list single interface types.
5506  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5507  */
5508 struct wiphy_radio {
5509 	const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range;
5510 	int n_freq_range;
5511 
5512 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5513 	int n_iface_combinations;
5514 };
5515 
5516 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5517 
5518 /**
5519  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5520  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5521  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5522  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5523  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5524  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5525  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5526  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5527  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5528  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5529  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5530  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5531  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5532  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5533  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5534  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5535  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5536  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5537  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5538  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5539  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5540  *	suites are specified separately.
5541  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5542  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5543  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5544  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5545  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5546  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5547  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5548  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5549  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5550  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5551  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5552  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5553  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5554  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5555  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5556  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5557  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5558  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5559  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5560  *	unregister hardware
5561  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5562  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5563  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5564  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5565  *	(see below).
5566  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5567  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5568  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5569  *	must be set by driver
5570  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5571  *	list single interface types.
5572  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5573  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5574  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5575  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5576  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5577  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5578  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5579  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5580  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5581  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5582  *	this variable determines its size
5583  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5584  *	any given scan
5585  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5586  *	the device can run concurrently.
5587  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5588  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5589  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5590  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5591  *	supported.
5592  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5593  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5594  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5595  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5596  *	scans
5597  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5598  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5599  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5600  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5601  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5602  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5603  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5604  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5605  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5606  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5607  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5608  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5609  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5610  *
5611  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5612  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5613  *	type
5614  *
5615  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5616  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5617  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5618  *
5619  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5620  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5621  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5622  *
5623  * @probe_resp_offload:
5624  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5625  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5626  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5627  *
5628  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5629  *	may request, if implemented.
5630  *
5631  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5632  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5633  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5634  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5635  *
5636  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5637  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5638  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5639  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5640  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5641  *
5642  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5643  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5644  *
5645  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5646  *	supports for ACL.
5647  *
5648  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5649  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5650  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5651  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5652  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5653  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5654  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5655  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5656  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5657  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5658  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5659  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5660  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5661  *
5662  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5663  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5664  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5665  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5666  *
5667  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5668  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5669  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5670  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5671  *
5672  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5673  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5674  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5675  *	infinite.
5676  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5677  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5678  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5679  *
5680  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5681  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5682  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5683  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5684  *
5685  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5686  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5687  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5688  *
5689  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5690  *	wake_tx_queue
5691  *
5692  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5693  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5694  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5695  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5696  *
5697  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5698  *
5699  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5700  *	device has
5701  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5702  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5703  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5704  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5705  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5706  *	long/short retry configuration
5707  *
5708  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5709  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5710  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5711  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5712  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5713  *
5714  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5715  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5716  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5717  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5718  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5719  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5720  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5721  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5722  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5723  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5724  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5725  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5726  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5727  *
5728  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5729  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5730  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5731  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5732  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5733  *	specify a mac address).
5734  *
5735  * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy
5736  * @n_radio: number of radios
5737  */
5738 struct wiphy {
5739 	struct mutex mtx;
5740 
5741 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5742 
5743 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5744 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5745 
5746 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5747 
5748 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5749 
5750 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5751 	int n_iface_combinations;
5752 	u16 software_iftypes;
5753 
5754 	u16 n_addresses;
5755 
5756 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5757 	u16 interface_modes;
5758 
5759 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5760 
5761 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5762 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5763 
5764 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5765 
5766 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5767 
5768 	int bss_priv_size;
5769 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5770 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5771 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5772 	u8 max_match_sets;
5773 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5774 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5775 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5776 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5777 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5778 
5779 	int n_cipher_suites;
5780 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5781 
5782 	int n_akm_suites;
5783 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5784 
5785 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5786 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5787 
5788 	u8 retry_short;
5789 	u8 retry_long;
5790 	u32 frag_threshold;
5791 	u32 rts_threshold;
5792 	u8 coverage_class;
5793 
5794 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5795 	u32 hw_version;
5796 
5797 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5798 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5799 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5800 #endif
5801 
5802 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5803 
5804 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5805 
5806 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5807 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5808 
5809 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5810 
5811 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5812 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5813 
5814 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5815 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5816 
5817 	const void *privid;
5818 
5819 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5820 
5821 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5822 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5823 
5824 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5825 
5826 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5827 
5828 	struct device dev;
5829 
5830 	bool registered;
5831 
5832 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5833 
5834 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5835 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5836 
5837 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5838 
5839 	possible_net_t _net;
5840 
5841 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5842 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5843 #endif
5844 
5845 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5846 
5847 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5848 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5849 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5850 
5851 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5852 
5853 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5854 
5855 	u32 bss_select_support;
5856 
5857 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5858 
5859 	u32 txq_limit;
5860 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5861 	u32 txq_quantum;
5862 
5863 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5864 
5865 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5866 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5867 
5868 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5869 
5870 	struct {
5871 		u64 peer, vif;
5872 		u8 max_retry;
5873 	} tid_config_support;
5874 
5875 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5876 
5877 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5878 
5879 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5880 
5881 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5882 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5883 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5884 
5885 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5886 
5887 	int n_radio;
5888 	const struct wiphy_radio *radio;
5889 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5890 
5891 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5892 };
5893 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5894 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5895 {
5896 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5897 }
5898 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5899 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5900 {
5901 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5902 }
5903 
5904 /**
5905  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5906  *
5907  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5908  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5909  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5910 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5911 {
5912 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5913 	return &wiphy->priv;
5914 }
5915 
5916 /**
5917  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5918  *
5919  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5920  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5921  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5922 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5923 {
5924 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5925 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5926 }
5927 
5928 /**
5929  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5930  *
5931  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5932  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5933  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5934 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5935 {
5936 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5937 }
5938 
5939 /**
5940  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5941  *
5942  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5943  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5944  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5945 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5946 {
5947 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5948 }
5949 
5950 /**
5951  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5952  *
5953  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5954  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5955  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5956 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5957 {
5958 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5959 }
5960 
5961 /**
5962  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5963  *
5964  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5965  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5966  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5967  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5968  *
5969  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5970  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5971  *
5972  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5973  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5974  */
5975 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5976 			   const char *requested_name);
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5980  *
5981  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5982  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5983  *
5984  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5985  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5986  *
5987  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5988  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5989  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5990 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5991 				      int sizeof_priv)
5992 {
5993 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5994 }
5995 
5996 /**
5997  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5998  *
5999  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
6000  *
6001  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
6002  */
6003 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6004 
6005 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
6006 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
6007 
6008 /**
6009  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
6010  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6011  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6012  *
6013  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
6014  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
6015  */
6016 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
6017         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6018 
6019 /**
6020  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
6021  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
6022  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
6023  *
6024  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
6025  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
6026  */
6027 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
6028         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
6029 
6030 /**
6031  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
6032  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
6033  *
6034  * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
6035  *
6036  * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
6037  */
6038 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6039 
6040 /**
6041  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
6042  *
6043  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
6044  *
6045  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
6046  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
6047  * request that is being handled.
6048  */
6049 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6050 
6051 /**
6052  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
6053  *
6054  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
6055  */
6056 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6057 
6058 /* internal structs */
6059 struct cfg80211_conn;
6060 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
6061 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
6062 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
6063 
6064 /**
6065  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
6066  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
6067  *
6068  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
6069  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
6070  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
6071  * differentiate which way it's called.
6072  *
6073  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
6074  *
6075  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
6076  *
6077  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
6078  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
6079  */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6080 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6081 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
6082 {
6083 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
6084 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
6085 }
6086 
6087 /**
6088  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
6089  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
6090  */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6091 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6092 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
6093 {
6094 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
6095 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
6096 }
6097 
6098 struct wiphy_work;
6099 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
6100 
6101 struct wiphy_work {
6102 	struct list_head entry;
6103 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
6104 };
6105 
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)6106 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
6107 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6108 {
6109 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
6110 	work->func = func;
6111 }
6112 
6113 /**
6114  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
6115  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6116  * @work: the work item
6117  *
6118  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6119  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6120  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6121  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6122  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6123  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6124  */
6125 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6126 
6127 /**
6128  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6129  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6130  * @work: the work to cancel
6131  *
6132  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6133  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6134  */
6135 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6136 
6137 /**
6138  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6139  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6140  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6141  *
6142  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6143  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6144  */
6145 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6146 
6147 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6148 	struct wiphy_work work;
6149 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6150 	struct timer_list timer;
6151 };
6152 
6153 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6154 
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6155 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6156 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
6157 {
6158 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6159 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6160 }
6161 
6162 /**
6163  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6164  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6165  * @dwork: the delayable worker
6166  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6167  *
6168  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6169  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6170  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6171  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6172  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6173  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6174  */
6175 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6176 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6177 			      unsigned long delay);
6178 
6179 /**
6180  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6181  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6182  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6183  *
6184  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6185  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6186  */
6187 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6188 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6189 
6190 /**
6191  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6192  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6193  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6194  *
6195  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6196  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6197  */
6198 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6199 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6200 
6201 /**
6202  * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable
6203  * work item is currently pending.
6204  *
6205  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6206  * @dwork: the delayed work in question
6207  *
6208  * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise
6209  *
6210  * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which
6211  * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work.
6212  * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is
6213  * called twice and the second call happens before the first call
6214  * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and
6215  * won't run before that.
6216  *
6217  * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling
6218  * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule
6219  * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to
6220  * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it
6221  * is currently executing.
6222  *
6223  *      CPU0                                CPU1
6224  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk)
6225  *  mod_timer(wk->timer)
6226  *                                     wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true
6227  *
6228  * [...]
6229  * expire_timers(wk->timer)
6230  *  detach_timer(wk->timer)
6231  *                                     wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false
6232  *  wk->timer->function()                          |
6233  *   wiphy_work_queue(wk)                          | delayed work pending
6234  *    list_add_tail()                              | returns false but
6235  *    queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work)              | wk->func() has not
6236  *                                                 | been run yet
6237  * [...]                                           |
6238  *  cfg80211_wiphy_work()                          |
6239  *   wk->func()                                    V
6240  *
6241  */
6242 bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6243 				struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6244 
6245 /**
6246  * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point
6247  *
6248  * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode
6249  * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point
6250  * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point
6251  * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point
6252  */
6253 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power {
6254 	IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP,
6255 	IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP,
6256 	IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP,
6257 	IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP,
6258 };
6259 
6260 /**
6261  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6262  *
6263  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6264  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6265  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6266  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6267  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6268  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6269  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6270  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6271  *
6272  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6273  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6274  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6275  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6276  *
6277  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6278  * @iftype: interface type
6279  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6280  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6281  *	for the notifier
6282  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6283  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6284  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6285  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6286  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6287  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6288  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6289  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6290  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6291  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6292  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6293  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6294  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6295  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6296  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6297  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6298  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6299  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6300  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6301  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6302  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6303  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6304  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6305  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6306  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6307  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6308  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6309  *	the P2P Device.
6310  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6311  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6312  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6313  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6314  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6315  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6316  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6317  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6318  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6319  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6320  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6321  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6322  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6323  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6324  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6325  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6326  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6327  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6328  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6329  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6330  *	unprotected beacon report
6331  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6332  *	@ap and @client for each link
6333  * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been
6334  *	started
6335  * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was
6336  *	entered.
6337  * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6338  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6339  * @radio_mask: Bitmask of radios that this interface is allowed to operate on.
6340  */
6341 struct wireless_dev {
6342 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6343 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6344 
6345 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6346 	struct list_head list;
6347 	struct net_device *netdev;
6348 
6349 	u32 identifier;
6350 
6351 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6352 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6353 
6354 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6355 
6356 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6357 
6358 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6359 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6360 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6361 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6362 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6363 
6364 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6365 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6366 
6367 	struct list_head event_list;
6368 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6369 
6370 	u8 connected:1;
6371 
6372 	bool ps;
6373 	int ps_timeout;
6374 
6375 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6376 
6377 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6378 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6379 
6380 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6381 	/* wext data */
6382 	struct {
6383 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6384 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6385 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6386 		const u8 *ie;
6387 		size_t ie_len;
6388 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6389 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6390 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6391 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6392 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6393 	} wext;
6394 #endif
6395 
6396 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6397 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6398 
6399 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6400 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6401 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6402 
6403 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6404 
6405 	union {
6406 		struct {
6407 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6408 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6409 			u8 ssid_len;
6410 		} client;
6411 		struct {
6412 			int beacon_interval;
6413 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6414 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6415 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6416 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6417 		} mesh;
6418 		struct {
6419 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6420 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6421 			u8 ssid_len;
6422 		} ap;
6423 		struct {
6424 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6425 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6426 			int beacon_interval;
6427 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6428 			u8 ssid_len;
6429 		} ibss;
6430 		struct {
6431 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6432 		} ocb;
6433 	} u;
6434 
6435 	struct {
6436 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6437 		union {
6438 			struct {
6439 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6440 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6441 			} ap;
6442 			struct {
6443 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6444 			} client;
6445 		};
6446 
6447 		bool cac_started;
6448 		unsigned long cac_start_time;
6449 		unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6450 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6451 	u16 valid_links;
6452 
6453 	u32 radio_mask;
6454 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
6455 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
6456 };
6457 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6458 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6459 {
6460 	if (wdev->netdev)
6461 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6462 	return wdev->address;
6463 }
6464 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6465 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6466 {
6467 	if (wdev->netdev)
6468 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6469 	return wdev->is_running;
6470 }
6471 
6472 /**
6473  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6474  *
6475  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6476  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6477  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6478 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6479 {
6480 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6481 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6482 }
6483 
6484 /**
6485  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6486  * @wdev: the wdev
6487  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6488  *
6489  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6490  */
6491 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6492 				       unsigned int link_id);
6493 
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6494 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6495 					unsigned int link_id)
6496 {
6497 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6498 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6499 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6500 }
6501 
6502 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6503 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6504 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6505 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6506 	     link_id++)						\
6507 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6508 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6509 
6510 /**
6511  * DOC: Utility functions
6512  *
6513  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6514  */
6515 
6516 /**
6517  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6518  *
6519  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6520  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6521  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6522  */
6523 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6524 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6525 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6526 {
6527 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6528 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6529 }
6530 
6531 /**
6532  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6533  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6534  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6535  */
6536 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6537 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6538 {
6539 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6540 }
6541 
6542 /**
6543  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6544  *
6545  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6546  * @chan: channel
6547  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6548  */
6549 enum nl80211_chan_width
6550 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6551 
6552 /**
6553  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6554  * @chan: channel number
6555  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6556  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6557  */
6558 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6559 
6560 /**
6561  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6562  * @chan: channel number
6563  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6564  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6565  */
6566 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6567 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6568 {
6569 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6570 }
6571 
6572 /**
6573  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6574  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6575  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6576  */
6577 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6578 
6579 /**
6580  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6581  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6582  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6583  */
6584 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6585 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6586 {
6587 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6588 }
6589 
6590 /**
6591  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6592  * frequency
6593  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6594  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6595  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6596  */
6597 struct ieee80211_channel *
6598 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6599 
6600 /**
6601  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6602  *
6603  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6604  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6605  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6606  */
6607 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6608 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6609 {
6610 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6611 }
6612 
6613 /**
6614  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6615  * @chan: control channel to check
6616  *
6617  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6618  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6619  *
6620  * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6621  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6622 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6623 {
6624 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6625 		return false;
6626 
6627 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6628 }
6629 
6630 /**
6631  * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef
6632  *
6633  * @radio: wiphy radio
6634  * @chandef: chandef for current channel
6635  *
6636  * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio
6637  */
6638 bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio,
6639 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
6640 
6641 /**
6642  * cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed - Check if the wdev may use the channel
6643  *
6644  * @wdev: the wireless device
6645  * @chan: channel to check
6646  *
6647  * Return: whether or not the wdev may use the channel
6648  */
6649 bool cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6650 				   struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6651 
6652 /**
6653  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6654  *
6655  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6656  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6657  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6658  *
6659  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6660  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6661  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6662  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6663  */
6664 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6665 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6666 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6667 
6668 /**
6669  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6670  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6671  *
6672  * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6673  * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6674  */
6675 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6676 
6677 /*
6678  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6679  *
6680  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6681  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6682  */
6683 
6684 struct radiotap_align_size {
6685 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6686 };
6687 
6688 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6689 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6690 	int n_bits;
6691 	uint32_t oui;
6692 	uint8_t subns;
6693 };
6694 
6695 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6696 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6697 	int n_ns;
6698 };
6699 
6700 /**
6701  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6702  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6703  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6704  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6705  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6706  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6707  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6708  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6709  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6710  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6711  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6712  *	radiotap namespace or not
6713  *
6714  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6715  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6716  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6717  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6718  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6719  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6720  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6721  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6722  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6723  *	next bitmap word
6724  *
6725  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6726  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6727  */
6728 
6729 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6730 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6731 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6732 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6733 
6734 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6735 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6736 
6737 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6738 	int this_arg_index;
6739 	int this_arg_size;
6740 
6741 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6742 
6743 	int _max_length;
6744 	int _arg_index;
6745 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6746 	int _reset_on_ext;
6747 };
6748 
6749 int
6750 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6751 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6752 				 int max_length,
6753 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6754 
6755 int
6756 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6757 
6758 
6759 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6760 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6761 
6762 /**
6763  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6764  *
6765  * @skb: the frame
6766  *
6767  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6768  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6769  *
6770  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6771  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6772  * 802.11 header.
6773  */
6774 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6775 
6776 /**
6777  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6778  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6779  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6780  */
6781 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6782 
6783 /**
6784  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6785  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6786  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6787  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6788  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6789  */
6790 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6791 
6792 /**
6793  * DOC: Data path helpers
6794  *
6795  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6796  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6797  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6798  */
6799 
6800 /**
6801  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6802  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6803  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6804  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6805  * @addr: the device MAC address
6806  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6807  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6808  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6809  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6810  */
6811 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6812 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6813 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6814 
6815 /**
6816  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6817  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6818  * @addr: the device MAC address
6819  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6820  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6821  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6822 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6823 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6824 {
6825 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6826 }
6827 
6828 /**
6829  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6830  *
6831  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6832  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6833  * mesh control field.
6834  *
6835  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6836  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6837  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6838  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6839  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6840  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6841  */
6842 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6843 
6844 /**
6845  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6846  *
6847  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6848  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6849  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6850  *
6851  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6852  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6853  *	initialized by the caller.
6854  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6855  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6856  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6857  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6858  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6859  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6860  */
6861 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6862 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6863 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6864 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6865 			      u8 mesh_control);
6866 
6867 /**
6868  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6869  *
6870  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6871  * protocol.
6872  *
6873  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6874  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6875  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6876  */
6877 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6878 
6879 /**
6880  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6881  *
6882  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6883  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6884  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6885  *
6886  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6887  *
6888  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6889  */
6890 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6891 
6892 /**
6893  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6894  * @skb: the data frame
6895  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6896  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6897  */
6898 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6899 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6900 
6901 /**
6902  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6903  *
6904  * @eid: element ID
6905  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6906  * @len: length of data
6907  * @match: byte array to match
6908  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6909  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6910  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6911  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6912  *	the data portion instead.
6913  *
6914  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6915  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6916  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6917  * requested element struct.
6918  *
6919  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6920  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6921  * byte array to match.
6922  */
6923 const struct element *
6924 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6925 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6926 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6927 
6928 /**
6929  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6930  *
6931  * @eid: element ID
6932  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6933  * @len: length of data
6934  * @match: byte array to match
6935  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6936  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6937  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6938  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6939  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6940  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6941  *
6942  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6943  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6944  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6945  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6946  * element ID.
6947  *
6948  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6949  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6950  * byte array to match.
6951  */
6952 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6953 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6954 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6955 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6956 {
6957 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6958 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6959 	 */
6960 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6961 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6962 		return NULL;
6963 
6964 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6965 						      match, match_len,
6966 						      match_offset ?
6967 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6968 }
6969 
6970 /**
6971  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6972  *
6973  * @eid: element ID
6974  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6975  * @len: length of data
6976  *
6977  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6978  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6979  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6980  * requested element struct.
6981  *
6982  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6983  * having to fit into the given data.
6984  */
6985 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6986 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6987 {
6988 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6989 }
6990 
6991 /**
6992  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6993  *
6994  * @eid: element ID
6995  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6996  * @len: length of data
6997  *
6998  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6999  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7000  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7001  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7002  *
7003  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7004  * having to fit into the given data.
7005  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7006 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7007 {
7008 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
7009 }
7010 
7011 /**
7012  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
7013  *
7014  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7015  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7016  * @len: length of data
7017  *
7018  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
7019  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7020  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
7021  * requested element struct.
7022  *
7023  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7024  * having to fit into the given data.
7025  */
7026 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7027 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7028 {
7029 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7030 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
7031 }
7032 
7033 /**
7034  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
7035  *
7036  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7037  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7038  * @len: length of data
7039  *
7040  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
7041  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7042  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7043  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7044  *
7045  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7046  * having to fit into the given data.
7047  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7048 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7049 {
7050 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7051 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
7052 }
7053 
7054 /**
7055  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
7056  *
7057  * @oui: vendor OUI
7058  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7059  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7060  * @len: length of data
7061  *
7062  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7063  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
7064  * return the element structure for the requested element.
7065  *
7066  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7067  * the given data.
7068  */
7069 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7070 						const u8 *ies,
7071 						unsigned int len);
7072 
7073 /**
7074  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
7075  *
7076  * @oui: vendor OUI
7077  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7078  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7079  * @len: length of data
7080  *
7081  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7082  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
7083  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
7084  * element ID.
7085  *
7086  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7087  * the given data.
7088  */
7089 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)7090 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7091 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
7092 {
7093 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
7094 }
7095 
7096 /**
7097  * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
7098  * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
7099  * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
7100  * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
7101  */
7102 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
7103 	RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
7104 	RNR_ITER_BREAK,
7105 	RNR_ITER_ERROR,
7106 };
7107 
7108 /**
7109  * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
7110  * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
7111  *	their entries in
7112  * @elems_len: length of the elements
7113  * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7114  *	for the return value
7115  * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
7116  * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
7117  *	or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
7118  *	%false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
7119  *	or elements were malformed.)
7120  */
7121 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
7122 		       enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7123 		       (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
7124 			       const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
7125 			       const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
7126 		       void *iter_data);
7127 
7128 /**
7129  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
7130  *
7131  * @elem: the element to defragment
7132  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
7133  * @ieslen: length of @ies
7134  * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
7135  * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
7136  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
7137  *
7138  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
7139  *
7140  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
7141  * skipping all headers.
7142  *
7143  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
7144  * element in-place.
7145  */
7146 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
7147 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
7148 				    u8 frag_id);
7149 
7150 /**
7151  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
7152  *
7153  * @dev: network device
7154  * @addr: STA MAC address
7155  *
7156  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
7157  * devices upon STA association.
7158  */
7159 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7160 
7161 /**
7162  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
7163  *
7164  * TODO
7165  */
7166 
7167 /**
7168  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
7169  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
7170  *	conflicts)
7171  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
7172  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
7173  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
7174  *	alpha2.
7175  *
7176  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
7177  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
7178  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
7179  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
7180  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
7181  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
7182  *
7183  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
7184  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
7185  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
7186  *
7187  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7188  * an -ENOMEM.
7189  *
7190  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
7191  */
7192 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
7193 
7194 /**
7195  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
7196  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7197  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7198  *
7199  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
7200  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
7201  * information.
7202  *
7203  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7204  */
7205 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7206 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7207 
7208 /**
7209  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7210  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7211  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7212  *
7213  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7214  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7215  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7216  *
7217  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7218  */
7219 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7220 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7221 
7222 /**
7223  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7224  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7225  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7226  *
7227  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7228  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7229  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7230  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7231  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7232  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7233  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7234  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7235  * that called this helper.
7236  */
7237 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7238 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7239 
7240 /**
7241  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7242  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7243  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7244  *
7245  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7246  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7247  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7248  * and processed already.
7249  *
7250  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7251  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7252  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7253  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7254  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7255  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7256  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7257  */
7258 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7259 					       u32 center_freq);
7260 
7261 /**
7262  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7263  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7264  *
7265  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7266  * proper string representation.
7267  *
7268  * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7269  */
7270 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7271 
7272 /**
7273  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7274  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7275  *
7276  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7277  *
7278  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7279  */
7280 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7281 
7282 /**
7283  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7284  *
7285  */
7286 
7287 /**
7288  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7289  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7290  *
7291  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7292  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7293  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7294  *
7295  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7296  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7297  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7298  *
7299  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7300  * an -ENODATA.
7301  *
7302  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7303  */
7304 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7305 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7306 
7307 /*
7308  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7309  * functions and BSS handling helpers
7310  */
7311 
7312 /**
7313  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7314  *
7315  * @request: the corresponding scan request
7316  * @info: information about the completed scan
7317  */
7318 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7319 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7320 
7321 /**
7322  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7323  *
7324  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7325  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7326  */
7327 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7328 
7329 /**
7330  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7331  *
7332  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7333  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7334  *
7335  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7336  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7337  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7338  */
7339 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7340 
7341 /**
7342  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7343  *
7344  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7345  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7346  *
7347  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7348  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7349  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7350  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7351  */
7352 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7353 
7354 /**
7355  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7356  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7357  * @data: the BSS metadata
7358  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7359  * @len: length of the management frame
7360  * @gfp: context flags
7361  *
7362  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7363  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7364  *
7365  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7366  * Or %NULL on error.
7367  */
7368 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7369 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7370 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7371 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7372 			       gfp_t gfp);
7373 
7374 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7375 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7376 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7377 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7378 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7379 {
7380 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7381 		.chan = rx_channel,
7382 		.signal = signal,
7383 	};
7384 
7385 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7386 }
7387 
7388 /**
7389  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7390  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7391  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7392  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7393  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7394  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7395 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7396 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7397 {
7398 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7399 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7400 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7401 
7402 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7403 
7404 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7405 
7406 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7407 }
7408 
7409 /**
7410  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7411  * @element: element to check
7412  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7413  *
7414  * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7415  */
7416 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7417 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7418 
7419 /**
7420  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7421  * @ie: ies
7422  * @ielen: length of IEs
7423  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7424  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7425  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7426  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7427  *
7428  * Return: the number of bytes merged
7429  */
7430 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7431 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7432 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7433 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7434 
7435 /**
7436  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7437  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7438  *	from a beacon or probe response
7439  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7440  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7441  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7442  */
7443 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7444 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7445 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7446 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7447 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7448 };
7449 
7450 /**
7451  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7452  * @ie: IEs
7453  * @ielen: length of IEs
7454  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7455  *
7456  * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7457  */
7458 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7459 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7460 
7461 /**
7462  * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7463  * @a: first SSID
7464  * @b: second SSID
7465  *
7466  * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7467  */
7468 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7469 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7470 {
7471 	if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7472 		return false;
7473 	if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7474 		return false;
7475 	return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7476 }
7477 
7478 /**
7479  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7480  *
7481  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7482  * @data: the BSS metadata
7483  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7484  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7485  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7486  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7487  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7488  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7489  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7490  * @gfp: context flags
7491  *
7492  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7493  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7494  *
7495  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7496  * Or %NULL on error.
7497  */
7498 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7499 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7500 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7501 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7502 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7503 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7504 			 gfp_t gfp);
7505 
7506 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7507 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7508 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7509 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7510 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7511 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7512 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7513 {
7514 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7515 		.chan = rx_channel,
7516 		.signal = signal,
7517 	};
7518 
7519 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7520 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7521 					gfp);
7522 }
7523 
7524 /**
7525  * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7526  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7527  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7528  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7529  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7530  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7531  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7532  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7533  * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7534  *
7535  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7536  */
7537 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7538 					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7539 					const u8 *bssid,
7540 					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7541 					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7542 					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7543 					u32 use_for);
7544 
7545 /**
7546  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7547  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7548  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7549  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7550  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7551  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7552  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7553  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7554  *
7555  * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7556  *
7557  * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7558  */
7559 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7560 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7561 		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7562 		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7563 		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7564 {
7565 	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7566 				  bss_type, privacy,
7567 				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7568 }
7569 
7570 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7571 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7572 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7573 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7574 {
7575 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7576 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7577 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7578 }
7579 
7580 /**
7581  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7582  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7583  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7584  *
7585  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7586  */
7587 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7588 
7589 /**
7590  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7591  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7592  * @bss: the BSS struct
7593  *
7594  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7595  */
7596 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7597 
7598 /**
7599  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7600  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7601  * @bss: the bss to remove
7602  *
7603  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7604  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7605  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7606  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7607  */
7608 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7609 
7610 /**
7611  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7612  *
7613  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7614  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7615  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7616  *
7617  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7618  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7619  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7620  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7621  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7622  */
7623 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7624 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7625 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7626 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7627 				    void *data),
7628 		       void *iter_data);
7629 
7630 /**
7631  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7632  * @dev: network device
7633  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7634  * @len: length of the frame data
7635  *
7636  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7637  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7638  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7639  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7640  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7641  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7642  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7643  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7644  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7645  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7646  *
7647  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7648  */
7649 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7650 
7651 /**
7652  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7653  * @dev: network device
7654  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7655  *
7656  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7657  * mutex.
7658  */
7659 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7660 
7661 /**
7662  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7663  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7664  * @len: length of the frame data
7665  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7666  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7667  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7668  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7669  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7670  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7671  *	non-MLO connections
7672  * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7673  *      pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7674  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7675  *	were rejected by the AP.
7676  */
7677 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7678 	const u8 *buf;
7679 	size_t len;
7680 	const u8 *req_ies;
7681 	size_t req_ies_len;
7682 	int uapsd_queues;
7683 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7684 	struct {
7685 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7686 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7687 		u16 status;
7688 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7689 };
7690 
7691 /**
7692  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7693  * @dev: network device
7694  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7695  *
7696  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7697  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7698  *
7699  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7700  */
7701 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7702 			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7703 
7704 /**
7705  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7706  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7707  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7708  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7709  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7710  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7711  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7712  */
7713 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7714 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7715 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7716 	bool timeout;
7717 };
7718 
7719 /**
7720  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7721  * @dev: network device
7722  * @data: data describing the association failure
7723  *
7724  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7725  */
7726 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7727 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7728 
7729 /**
7730  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7731  * @dev: network device
7732  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7733  * @len: length of the frame data
7734  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7735  *
7736  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7737  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7738  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7739  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7740  */
7741 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7742 			   bool reconnect);
7743 
7744 /**
7745  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7746  * @dev: network device
7747  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7748  * @len: length of the frame data
7749  *
7750  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7751  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7752  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7753  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7754  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7755  *
7756  * This function may sleep.
7757  */
7758 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7759 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7760 
7761 /**
7762  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7763  * @dev: network device
7764  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7765  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7766  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7767  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7768  * @gfp: allocation flags
7769  *
7770  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7771  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7772  * primitive.
7773  */
7774 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7775 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7776 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7777 
7778 /**
7779  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7780  *
7781  * @dev: network device
7782  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7783  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7784  * @gfp: allocation flags
7785  *
7786  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7787  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7788  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7789  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7790  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7791  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7792  */
7793 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7794 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7795 
7796 /**
7797  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7798  * 					candidate
7799  *
7800  * @dev: network device
7801  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7802  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7803  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7804  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7805  * @gfp: allocation flags
7806  *
7807  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7808  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7809  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7810  */
7811 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7812 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7813 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7814 
7815 /**
7816  * DOC: RFkill integration
7817  *
7818  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7819  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7820  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7821  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7822  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7823  *
7824  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7825  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7826  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7827  */
7828 
7829 /**
7830  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7831  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7832  * @blocked: block status
7833  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7834  */
7835 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7836 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7837 
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7838 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7839 {
7840 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7841 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7842 }
7843 
7844 /**
7845  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7846  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7847  */
7848 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7849 
7850 /**
7851  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7852  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7853  */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7854 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7855 {
7856 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7857 }
7858 
7859 /**
7860  * DOC: Vendor commands
7861  *
7862  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7863  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7864  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7865  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7866  * the configuration mechanism.
7867  *
7868  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7869  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7870  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7871  *
7872  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7873  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7874  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7875  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7876  * managers etc. need.
7877  */
7878 
7879 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7880 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7881 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7882 					   int approxlen);
7883 
7884 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7885 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7886 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7887 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7888 					   unsigned int portid,
7889 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7890 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7891 
7892 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7893 
7894 /**
7895  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7896  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7897  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7898  *	be put into the skb
7899  *
7900  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7901  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7902  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7903  *
7904  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7905  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7906  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7907  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7908  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7909  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7910  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7911  *
7912  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7913  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7914  *
7915  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7916  */
7917 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7918 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7919 {
7920 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7921 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7922 }
7923 
7924 /**
7925  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7926  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7927  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7928  *
7929  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7930  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7931  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7932  * skb regardless of the return value.
7933  *
7934  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7935  */
7936 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7937 
7938 /**
7939  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7940  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7941  *
7942  * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7943  *
7944  * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7945  */
7946 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7947 
7948 /**
7949  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7950  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7951  * @wdev: the wireless device
7952  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7953  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7954  *	be put into the skb
7955  * @gfp: allocation flags
7956  *
7957  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7958  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7959  *
7960  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7961  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7962  * attribute.
7963  *
7964  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7965  * skb to send the event.
7966  *
7967  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7968  */
7969 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7970 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7971 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7972 {
7973 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7974 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7975 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7976 }
7977 
7978 /**
7979  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7980  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7981  * @wdev: the wireless device
7982  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7983  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7984  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7985  *	be put into the skb
7986  * @gfp: allocation flags
7987  *
7988  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7989  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7990  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7991  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7992  *
7993  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7994  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7995  * attribute.
7996  *
7997  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7998  * skb to send the event.
7999  *
8000  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8001  */
8002 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)8003 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8004 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8005 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
8006 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
8007 {
8008 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
8009 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
8010 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
8011 }
8012 
8013 /**
8014  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
8015  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
8016  * @gfp: allocation flags
8017  *
8018  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8019  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
8020  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8021 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8022 {
8023 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8024 }
8025 
8026 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
8027 /**
8028  * DOC: Test mode
8029  *
8030  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
8031  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
8032  * factory programming.
8033  *
8034  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
8035  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
8036  */
8037 
8038 /**
8039  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
8040  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8041  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8042  *	be put into the skb
8043  *
8044  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
8045  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
8046  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
8047  *
8048  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
8049  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
8050  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
8051  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
8052  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
8053  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
8054  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
8055  *
8056  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
8057  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
8058  *
8059  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8060  */
8061 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)8062 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
8063 {
8064 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8065 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
8066 }
8067 
8068 /**
8069  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
8070  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8071  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
8072  *
8073  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
8074  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
8075  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
8076  * regardless of the return value.
8077  *
8078  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
8079  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)8080 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
8081 {
8082 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
8083 }
8084 
8085 /**
8086  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
8087  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8088  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8089  *	be put into the skb
8090  * @gfp: allocation flags
8091  *
8092  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
8093  * testmode multicast group.
8094  *
8095  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
8096  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
8097  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
8098  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
8099  * in any other way.
8100  *
8101  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
8102  * skb to send the event.
8103  *
8104  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8105  */
8106 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)8107 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
8108 {
8109 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8110 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
8111 					  approxlen, gfp);
8112 }
8113 
8114 /**
8115  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
8116  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8117  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
8118  * @gfp: allocation flags
8119  *
8120  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8121  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
8122  * consumes it.
8123  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8124 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8125 {
8126 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8127 }
8128 
8129 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
8130 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
8131 #else
8132 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
8133 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
8134 #endif
8135 
8136 /**
8137  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
8138  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
8139  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
8140  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
8141  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
8142  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
8143  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
8144  *	status for a FILS connection.
8145  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8146  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
8147  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
8148  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8149  */
8150 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
8151 	const u8 *kek;
8152 	size_t kek_len;
8153 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
8154 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
8155 	const u8 *pmk;
8156 	size_t pmk_len;
8157 	const u8 *pmkid;
8158 };
8159 
8160 /**
8161  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
8162  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8163  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8164  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8165  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8166  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8167  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8168  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8169  *	case.
8170  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
8171  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
8172  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8173  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
8174  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
8175  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8176  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8177  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8178  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8179  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8180  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8181  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
8182  *	zero.
8183  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8184  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
8185  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
8186  *	connected AP info.
8187  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
8188  *	%NULL.
8189  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
8190  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
8191  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
8192  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
8193  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
8194  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
8195  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
8196  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
8197  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
8198  *	to be specified.
8199  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
8200  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
8201  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
8202  */
8203 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8204 	int status;
8205 	const u8 *req_ie;
8206 	size_t req_ie_len;
8207 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8208 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8209 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8210 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8211 
8212 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8213 	u16 valid_links;
8214 	struct {
8215 		const u8 *addr;
8216 		const u8 *bssid;
8217 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8218 		u16 status;
8219 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8220 };
8221 
8222 /**
8223  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8224  *
8225  * @dev: network device
8226  * @params: connection response parameters
8227  * @gfp: allocation flags
8228  *
8229  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8230  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8231  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8232  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8233  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8234  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8235  */
8236 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8237 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8238 			   gfp_t gfp);
8239 
8240 /**
8241  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8242  *
8243  * @dev: network device
8244  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8245  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8246  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8247  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8248  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8249  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8250  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8251  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8252  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8253  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8254  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8255  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8256  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8257  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8258  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8259  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8260  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8261  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8262  *	case.
8263  * @gfp: allocation flags
8264  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8265  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8266  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8267  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8268  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8269  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8270  *
8271  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8272  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8273  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8274  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8275  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8276  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8277  */
8278 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8279 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8280 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8281 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8282 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8283 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8284 {
8285 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8286 
8287 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
8288 	params.status = status;
8289 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8290 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
8291 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
8292 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8293 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8294 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8295 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8296 
8297 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
8298 }
8299 
8300 /**
8301  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8302  *
8303  * @dev: network device
8304  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8305  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8306  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8307  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8308  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8309  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8310  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8311  *	the real status code for failures.
8312  * @gfp: allocation flags
8313  *
8314  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8315  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8316  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8317  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8318  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8319  */
8320 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8321 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8322 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8323 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8324 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8325 {
8326 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8327 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8328 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8329 }
8330 
8331 /**
8332  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8333  *
8334  * @dev: network device
8335  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8336  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8337  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8338  * @gfp: allocation flags
8339  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8340  *
8341  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8342  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8343  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8344  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8345  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8346  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8347  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8348  */
8349 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8350 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8351 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8352 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8353 {
8354 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8355 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8356 }
8357 
8358 /**
8359  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8360  *
8361  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8362  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8363  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8364  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8365  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8366  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8367  *	Otherwise zero.
8368  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8369  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8370  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8371  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8372  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8373  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8374  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8375  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8376  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8377  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8378  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8379  */
8380 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8381 	const u8 *req_ie;
8382 	size_t req_ie_len;
8383 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8384 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8385 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8386 
8387 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8388 	u16 valid_links;
8389 	struct {
8390 		const u8 *addr;
8391 		const u8 *bssid;
8392 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8393 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8394 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8395 };
8396 
8397 /**
8398  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8399  *
8400  * @dev: network device
8401  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8402  * @gfp: allocation flags
8403  *
8404  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8405  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8406  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8407  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8408  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8409  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8410  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8411  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8412  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8413  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8414  */
8415 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8416 		     gfp_t gfp);
8417 
8418 /**
8419  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8420  *
8421  * @dev: network device
8422  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8423  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8424  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8425  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8426  * @gfp: allocation flags
8427  *
8428  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8429  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8430  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8431  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8432  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8433  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8434  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8435  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8436  * associated STA/GC.
8437  */
8438 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8439 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8440 
8441 /**
8442  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8443  *
8444  * @dev: network device
8445  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8446  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8447  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8448  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8449  * @gfp: allocation flags
8450  *
8451  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8452  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8453  */
8454 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8455 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8456 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8457 
8458 /**
8459  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8460  * @wdev: wireless device
8461  * @cookie: the request cookie
8462  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8463  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8464  *	channel
8465  * @gfp: allocation flags
8466  */
8467 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8468 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8469 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8470 
8471 /**
8472  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8473  * @wdev: wireless device
8474  * @cookie: the request cookie
8475  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8476  * @gfp: allocation flags
8477  */
8478 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8479 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8480 					gfp_t gfp);
8481 
8482 /**
8483  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8484  * @wdev: wireless device
8485  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8486  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8487  * @gfp: allocation flags
8488  */
8489 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8490 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8491 
8492 /**
8493  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8494  *
8495  * @sinfo: the station information
8496  * @gfp: allocation flags
8497  *
8498  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8499  */
8500 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8501 
8502 /**
8503  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8504  * @sinfo: the station information
8505  *
8506  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8507  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8508  * the stack.)
8509  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8510 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8511 {
8512 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8513 }
8514 
8515 /**
8516  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8517  *
8518  * @dev: the netdev
8519  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8520  * @sinfo: the station information
8521  * @gfp: allocation flags
8522  */
8523 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8524 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8525 
8526 /**
8527  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8528  * @dev: the netdev
8529  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8530  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8531  * @gfp: allocation flags
8532  */
8533 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8534 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8535 
8536 /**
8537  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8538  *
8539  * @dev: the netdev
8540  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8541  * @gfp: allocation flags
8542  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8543 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8544 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8545 {
8546 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8547 }
8548 
8549 /**
8550  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8551  *
8552  * @dev: the netdev
8553  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8554  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8555  * @gfp: allocation flags
8556  *
8557  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8558  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8559  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8560  *
8561  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8562  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8563  */
8564 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8565 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8566 			  gfp_t gfp);
8567 
8568 /**
8569  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8570  *
8571  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8572  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8573  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8574  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8575  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8576  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8577  * @len: length of the frame data
8578  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8579  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8580  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8581  */
8582 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8583 	int freq;
8584 	int sig_dbm;
8585 	bool have_link_id;
8586 	u8 link_id;
8587 	const u8 *buf;
8588 	size_t len;
8589 	u32 flags;
8590 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8591 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8592 };
8593 
8594 /**
8595  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8596  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8597  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8598  *
8599  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8600  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8601  *
8602  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8603  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8604  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8605  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8606  */
8607 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8608 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8609 
8610 /**
8611  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8612  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8613  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8614  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8615  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8616  * @len: length of the frame data
8617  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8618  *
8619  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8620  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8621  *
8622  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8623  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8624  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8625  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8626  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8627 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8628 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8629 					u32 flags)
8630 {
8631 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8632 		.freq = freq,
8633 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8634 		.buf = buf,
8635 		.len = len,
8636 		.flags = flags
8637 	};
8638 
8639 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8640 }
8641 
8642 /**
8643  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8644  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8645  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8646  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8647  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8648  * @len: length of the frame data
8649  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8650  *
8651  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8652  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8653  *
8654  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8655  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8656  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8657  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8658  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8659 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8660 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8661 				    u32 flags)
8662 {
8663 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8664 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8665 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8666 		.buf = buf,
8667 		.len = len,
8668 		.flags = flags
8669 	};
8670 
8671 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8672 }
8673 
8674 /**
8675  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8676  *
8677  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8678  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8679  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8680  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8681  * @len: length of the frame data
8682  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8683  */
8684 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8685 	u64 cookie;
8686 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8687 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8688 	const u8 *buf;
8689 	size_t len;
8690 	bool ack;
8691 };
8692 
8693 /**
8694  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8695  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8696  * @status: TX status data
8697  * @gfp: context flags
8698  *
8699  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8700  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8701  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8702  */
8703 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8704 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8705 
8706 /**
8707  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8708  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8709  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8710  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8711  * @len: length of the frame data
8712  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8713  * @gfp: context flags
8714  *
8715  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8716  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8717  * transmission attempt.
8718  */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8719 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8720 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8721 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8722 {
8723 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8724 		.cookie = cookie,
8725 		.buf = buf,
8726 		.len = len,
8727 		.ack = ack
8728 	};
8729 
8730 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8731 }
8732 
8733 /**
8734  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8735  *                                   port frames
8736  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8737  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8738  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8739  * @len: length of the frame data
8740  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8741  * @gfp: context flags
8742  *
8743  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8744  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8745  * the transmission attempt.
8746  */
8747 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8748 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8749 				     gfp_t gfp);
8750 
8751 /**
8752  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8753  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8754  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8755  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8756  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8757  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8758  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8759  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8760  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8761  *
8762  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8763  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8764  * control port frames over nl80211.
8765  *
8766  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8767  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8768  *
8769  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8770  */
8771 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8772 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8773 
8774 /**
8775  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8776  * @dev: network device
8777  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8778  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8779  * @gfp: context flags
8780  *
8781  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8782  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8783  */
8784 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8785 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8786 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8787 
8788 /**
8789  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8790  * @dev: network device
8791  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8792  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8793  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8794  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8795  * @gfp: context flags
8796  */
8797 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8798 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8799 
8800 /**
8801  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8802  * @dev: network device
8803  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8804  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8805  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8806  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8807  * @gfp: context flags
8808  *
8809  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8810  * given interval is exceeded.
8811  */
8812 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8813 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8814 
8815 /**
8816  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8817  * @dev: network device
8818  * @gfp: context flags
8819  *
8820  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8821  */
8822 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8823 
8824 /**
8825  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8826  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8827  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8828  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8829  * @gfp: context flags
8830  *
8831  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8832  */
8833 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8834 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8835 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8836 
8837 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8838 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8839 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8840 		     gfp_t gfp)
8841 {
8842 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8843 }
8844 
8845 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8846 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8847 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8848 				gfp_t gfp)
8849 {
8850 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8851 }
8852 
8853 /**
8854  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8855  * @dev: network device
8856  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8857  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8858  * @gfp: context flags
8859  *
8860  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8861  * frame.
8862  */
8863 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8864 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8865 				       gfp_t gfp);
8866 
8867 /**
8868  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8869  * @netdev: network device
8870  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8871  * @event: type of event
8872  * @gfp: context flags
8873  * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise.
8874  *
8875  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8876  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8877  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8878  */
8879 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8880 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8881 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp,
8882 			unsigned int link_id);
8883 
8884 /**
8885  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8886  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8887  *
8888  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8889  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8890  */
8891 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8892 
8893 /**
8894  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8895  * @dev: network device
8896  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8897  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8898  * @gfp: allocation flags
8899  */
8900 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8901 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8902 
8903 /**
8904  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8905  * @dev: network device
8906  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8907  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8908  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8909  * @gfp: allocation flags
8910  */
8911 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8912 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8913 
8914 /**
8915  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8916  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8917  * @addr: the transmitter address
8918  * @gfp: context flags
8919  *
8920  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8921  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8922  * sender.
8923  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8924  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8925  */
8926 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8927 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8928 
8929 /**
8930  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8931  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8932  * @addr: the transmitter address
8933  * @gfp: context flags
8934  *
8935  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8936  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8937  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8938  * station to avoid event flooding.
8939  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8940  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8941  */
8942 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8943 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8944 
8945 /**
8946  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8947  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8948  * @addr: the address of the peer
8949  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8950  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8951  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8952  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8953  * @gfp: allocation flags
8954  */
8955 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8956 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8957 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8958 
8959 /**
8960  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8961  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8962  * @frame: the frame
8963  * @len: length of the frame
8964  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8965  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8966  *
8967  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8968  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8969  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8970  */
8971 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8972 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8973 
8974 /**
8975  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8976  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8977  * @frame: the frame
8978  * @len: length of the frame
8979  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8980  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8981  *
8982  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8983  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8984  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8985  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8986 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8987 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8988 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8989 {
8990 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8991 					sig_dbm);
8992 }
8993 
8994 /**
8995  * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration
8996  * @iftype: the interface type to check for
8997  * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another
8998  *	interface connected already on the same channel)
8999  *	NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held.
9000  * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the
9001  *	advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting
9002  */
9003 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config {
9004 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
9005 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power;
9006 	bool relax;
9007 };
9008 
9009 /**
9010  * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed
9011  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9012  * @chandef: the channel definition
9013  * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking
9014  *
9015  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9016  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9017  */
9018 bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9019 				  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9020 				  struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg);
9021 
9022 /**
9023  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
9024  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9025  * @chandef: the channel definition
9026  * @iftype: interface type
9027  *
9028  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9029  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
9030  */
9031 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9032 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9033 			struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9034 			enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9035 {
9036 	struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9037 		.iftype = iftype,
9038 	};
9039 
9040 	return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9041 }
9042 
9043 /**
9044  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
9045  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9046  * @chandef: the channel definition
9047  * @iftype: interface type
9048  *
9049  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9050  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
9051  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
9052  * more permissive conditions.
9053  *
9054  * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
9055  */
9056 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9057 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9058 			      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9059 			      enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9060 {
9061 	struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9062 		.iftype = iftype,
9063 		.relax = true,
9064 	};
9065 
9066 	return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9067 }
9068 
9069 /**
9070  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
9071  * @dev: the device which switched channels
9072  * @chandef: the new channel definition
9073  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9074  *
9075  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
9076  * driver context!
9077  */
9078 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9079 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9080 			       unsigned int link_id);
9081 
9082 /**
9083  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
9084  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
9085  * @chandef: the future channel definition
9086  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9087  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
9088  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
9089  *
9090  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
9091  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
9092  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
9093  */
9094 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9095 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9096 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
9097 				       bool quiet);
9098 
9099 /**
9100  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
9101  *
9102  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9103  * @band: band pointer to fill
9104  *
9105  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9106  */
9107 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
9108 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
9109 
9110 /**
9111  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
9112  *
9113  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9114  * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
9115  * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
9116  *
9117  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9118  */
9119 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
9120 					  struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
9121 					  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9122 
9123 /**
9124  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
9125  *
9126  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9127  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
9128  *
9129  * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9130  */
9131 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9132 					  u8 *op_class);
9133 
9134 /**
9135  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
9136  *
9137  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9138  *
9139  * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
9140  */
9141 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)9142 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
9143 {
9144 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
9145 }
9146 
9147 /**
9148  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
9149  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
9150  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
9151  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
9152  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
9153  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
9154  * @gfp: allocation flags
9155  *
9156  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
9157  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
9158  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
9159  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
9160  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
9161  */
9162 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
9163 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
9164 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
9165 
9166 /**
9167  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
9168  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
9169  *
9170  * Return: calculated bitrate
9171  */
9172 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
9173 
9174 /**
9175  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
9176  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
9177  *
9178  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
9179  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
9180  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
9181  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
9182  * is unbound from the driver.
9183  *
9184  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9185  */
9186 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9187 
9188 /**
9189  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
9190  * @dev: the netdev to register
9191  *
9192  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9193  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
9194  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
9195  * instead as well.
9196  *
9197  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9198  *
9199  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9200  */
9201 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
9202 
9203 /**
9204  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
9205  * @dev: the netdev to register
9206  *
9207  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9208  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
9209  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
9210  * usable instead as well.
9211  *
9212  * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9213  */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)9214 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
9215 {
9216 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
9217 }
9218 
9219 /**
9220  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
9221  * @ies: FT IEs
9222  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
9223  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
9224  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
9225  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
9226  */
9227 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
9228 	const u8 *ies;
9229 	size_t ies_len;
9230 	const u8 *target_ap;
9231 	const u8 *ric_ies;
9232 	size_t ric_ies_len;
9233 };
9234 
9235 /**
9236  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
9237  * @netdev: network device
9238  * @ft_event: IE information
9239  */
9240 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9241 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
9242 
9243 /**
9244  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
9245  * @ies: the input IE buffer
9246  * @len: the input length
9247  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
9248  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9249  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9250  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9251  *
9252  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9253  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9254  *
9255  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9256  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9257  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9258  */
9259 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9260 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9261 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9262 
9263 /**
9264  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9265  * @ies: the IE buffer
9266  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9267  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9268  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9269  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9270  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9271  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9272  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9273  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9274  *
9275  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9276  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9277  * split.
9278  *
9279  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9280  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9281  *
9282  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9283  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9284  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9285  *
9286  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9287  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9288  * used.
9289  */
9290 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9291 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9292 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9293 			      size_t offset);
9294 
9295 /**
9296  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9297  * @ies: the IE buffer
9298  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9299  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9300  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9301  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9302  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9303  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9304  *
9305  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9306  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9307  * split.
9308  *
9309  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9310  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9311  *
9312  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9313  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9314  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9315  *
9316  * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9317  * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9318  * used.
9319  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9320 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9321 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9322 {
9323 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9324 }
9325 
9326 /**
9327  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9328  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9329  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9330  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9331  *
9332  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9333  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9334  * accordingly.
9335  */
9336 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9337 
9338 /**
9339  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9340  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9341  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9342  * @gfp: allocation flags
9343  *
9344  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9345  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9346  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9347  * else caused the wakeup.
9348  */
9349 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9350 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9351 				   gfp_t gfp);
9352 
9353 /**
9354  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9355  *
9356  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9357  * @gfp: allocation flags
9358  *
9359  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9360  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9361  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9362  */
9363 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9364 
9365 /**
9366  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9367  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9368  *
9369  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9370  */
9371 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9372 
9373 /**
9374  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9375  *
9376  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9377  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9378  *
9379  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9380  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9381  * the interface combinations.
9382  *
9383  * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9384  */
9385 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9386 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9387 
9388 /**
9389  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9390  *
9391  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9392  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9393  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9394  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9395  *
9396  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9397  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9398  * purposes.
9399  *
9400  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9401  */
9402 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9403 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9404 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9405 					    void *data),
9406 			       void *data);
9407 
9408 /**
9409  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9410  *
9411  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9412  * @wdev: wireless device
9413  * @gfp: context flags
9414  *
9415  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9416  * disconnected.
9417  *
9418  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9419  */
9420 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9421 			 gfp_t gfp);
9422 
9423 /**
9424  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9425  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9426  *
9427  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9428  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9429  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9430  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9431  *
9432  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9433  * the driver while the function is running.
9434  */
9435 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9436 
9437 /**
9438  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9439  *
9440  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9441  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9442  *
9443  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9444  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9445  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9446 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9447 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9448 {
9449 	u8 *ft_byte;
9450 
9451 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9452 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9453 }
9454 
9455 /**
9456  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9457  *
9458  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9459  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9460  *
9461  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9462  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9463  *
9464  * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9465  */
9466 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9467 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9468 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9469 {
9470 	u8 ft_byte;
9471 
9472 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9473 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9474 }
9475 
9476 /**
9477  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9478  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9479  *
9480  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9481  */
9482 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9483 
9484 /**
9485  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9486  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9487  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9488  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9489  *	 result.
9490  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9491  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9492  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9493  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9494  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9495  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9496  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9497  */
9498 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9499 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9500 	u8 inst_id;
9501 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9502 	const u8 *addr;
9503 	u8 info_len;
9504 	const u8 *info;
9505 	u64 cookie;
9506 };
9507 
9508 /**
9509  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9510  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9511  * @match: match notification parameters
9512  * @gfp: allocation flags
9513  *
9514  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9515  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9516  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9517  */
9518 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9519 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9520 
9521 /**
9522  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9523  *
9524  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9525  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9526  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9527  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9528  * @gfp: allocation flags
9529  *
9530  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9531  */
9532 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9533 				  u8 inst_id,
9534 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9535 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9536 
9537 /* ethtool helper */
9538 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9539 
9540 /**
9541  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9542  * @netdev: network device
9543  * @params: External authentication parameters
9544  * @gfp: allocation flags
9545  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9546  */
9547 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9548 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9549 				   gfp_t gfp);
9550 
9551 /**
9552  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9553  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9554  * @req: the original measurement request
9555  * @result: the result data
9556  * @gfp: allocation flags
9557  */
9558 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9559 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9560 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9561 			  gfp_t gfp);
9562 
9563 /**
9564  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9565  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9566  * @req: the original measurement request
9567  * @gfp: allocation flags
9568  *
9569  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9570  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9571  */
9572 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9573 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9574 			    gfp_t gfp);
9575 
9576 /**
9577  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9578  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9579  * @iftype: interface type
9580  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9581  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9582  *
9583  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9584  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9585  * check_swif is '1'.
9586  *
9587  * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9588  */
9589 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9590 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9591 
9592 
9593 /**
9594  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9595  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9596  * @netdev: network device
9597  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9598  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9599  *
9600  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9601  */
9602 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9603 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9604 
9605 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9606 
9607 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9608 
9609 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9610 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9611 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9612 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9613 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9614 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9615 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9616 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9617 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9618 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9619 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9620 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9621 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9622 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9623 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9624 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9625 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9626 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9627 
9628 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9629 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9630 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9631 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9632 
9633 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9634 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9635 
9636 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9637 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9638 
9639 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9640 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9641 #else
9642 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9643 ({									\
9644 	if (0)								\
9645 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9646 	0;								\
9647 })
9648 #endif
9649 
9650 /*
9651  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9652  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9653  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9654  */
9655 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9656 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9657 
9658 /**
9659  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9660  * @netdev: network device
9661  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9662  * @gfp: allocation flags
9663  */
9664 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9665 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9666 				    gfp_t gfp);
9667 
9668 /**
9669  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9670  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9671  */
9672 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9673 
9674 /**
9675  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9676  * @dev: network device
9677  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9678  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9679  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9680  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9681  *
9682  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9683  */
9684 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9685 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9686 			      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9687 
9688 /**
9689  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9690  * @dev: network device
9691  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9692  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9693  *
9694  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9695  */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9696 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9697 						       u64 color_bitmap,
9698 						       u8 link_id)
9699 {
9700 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9701 					 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9702 }
9703 
9704 /**
9705  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9706  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9707  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9708  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9709  *
9710  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9711  *
9712  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9713  */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9714 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9715 						       u8 count, u8 link_id)
9716 {
9717 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9718 					 count, 0, link_id);
9719 }
9720 
9721 /**
9722  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9723  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9724  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9725  *
9726  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9727  *
9728  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9729  */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9730 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9731 						       u8 link_id)
9732 {
9733 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9734 					 0, 0, link_id);
9735 }
9736 
9737 /**
9738  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9739  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9740  * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9741  *
9742  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9743  *
9744  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9745  */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9746 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9747 					       u8 link_id)
9748 {
9749 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9750 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9751 					 0, 0, link_id);
9752 }
9753 
9754 /**
9755  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9756  * @dev: network device.
9757  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9758  *
9759  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9760  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9761  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9762  * case disconnect instead.
9763  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9764  */
9765 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9766 
9767 /**
9768  * struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data - MLO reconfiguration data
9769  * @buf: MLO Reconfiguration Response frame (header + body)
9770  * @len: length of the frame data
9771  * @driver_initiated: Indicates whether the add links request is initiated by
9772  *	driver. This is set to true when the link reconfiguration request
9773  *	initiated by driver due to AP link recommendation requests
9774  *	(Ex: BTM (BSS Transition Management) request) handling offloaded to
9775  *	driver.
9776  * @added_links: BIT mask of links successfully added to the association
9777  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID
9778  * @links.bss: the BSS that MLO reconfiguration was requested for, ownership of
9779  *      the pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to
9780  *      cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done().
9781  *
9782  * The BSS pointer must be set for each link for which 'add' operation was
9783  * requested in the assoc_ml_reconf callback.
9784  */
9785 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data {
9786 	const u8 *buf;
9787 	size_t len;
9788 	bool driver_initiated;
9789 	u16 added_links;
9790 	struct {
9791 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
9792 		u8 *addr;
9793 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
9794 };
9795 
9796 /**
9797  * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done - Notify about MLO reconfiguration result
9798  * @dev: network device.
9799  * @data: MLO reconfiguration done data, &struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data
9800  *
9801  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace that processing of ML reconfiguration
9802  * request to add links to the association is done.
9803  */
9804 void cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(struct net_device *dev,
9805 				  struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data *data);
9806 
9807 /**
9808  * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9809  * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9810  *
9811  * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9812  * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9813  * hold anymore.
9814  */
9815 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9816 
9817 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9818 /**
9819  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9820  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9821  * @file: the file being read
9822  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9823  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9824  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9825  * @count: read count
9826  * @ppos: read position
9827  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9828  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9829  *
9830  * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9831  */
9832 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9833 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9834 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9835 				  loff_t *ppos,
9836 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9837 						     struct file *file,
9838 						     char *buf,
9839 						     size_t bufsize,
9840 						     void *data),
9841 				  void *data);
9842 
9843 /**
9844  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9845  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9846  * @file: the file being written to
9847  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9848  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9849  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9850  * @count: read count
9851  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9852  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9853  *
9854  * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9855  */
9856 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9857 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9858 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9859 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9860 						      struct file *file,
9861 						      char *buf,
9862 						      size_t count,
9863 						      void *data),
9864 				   void *data);
9865 #endif
9866 
9867 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9868